elf32-ppc.c revision 1.10 1 1.1 christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 1.10 christos Copyright (C) 1994-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 1.1 christos Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 1.1 christos
5 1.1 christos This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 christos
7 1.1 christos This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 christos it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 christos the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 christos (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 christos
12 1.1 christos This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 christos but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 christos MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 christos GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 christos
17 1.1 christos You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 christos along with this program; if not, write to the
19 1.1 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 1.1 christos Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 christos
22 1.10 christos /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
23 1.10 christos when they appear unused. The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
24 1.10 christos needs them. */
25 1.10 christos #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
26 1.1 christos
27 1.1 christos #include "sysdep.h"
28 1.1 christos #include <stdarg.h>
29 1.1 christos #include "bfd.h"
30 1.1 christos #include "bfdlink.h"
31 1.1 christos #include "libbfd.h"
32 1.1 christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
33 1.1 christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
34 1.1 christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
35 1.1 christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
36 1.1 christos #include "dwarf2.h"
37 1.7 christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
38 1.1 christos
39 1.9 christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
40 1.9 christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
41 1.9 christos
42 1.1 christos typedef enum split16_format_type
43 1.1 christos {
44 1.1 christos split16a_type = 0,
45 1.1 christos split16d_type
46 1.1 christos }
47 1.1 christos split16_format_type;
48 1.1 christos
49 1.1 christos /* RELA relocations are used here. */
50 1.1 christos
51 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
52 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
54 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55 1.1 christos
56 1.1 christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
57 1.1 christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
58 1.1 christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
59 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
60 1.1 christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
61 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
62 1.1 christos
63 1.1 christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
64 1.1 christos section. */
65 1.1 christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
66 1.1 christos
67 1.1 christos /* For old-style PLT. */
68 1.1 christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
69 1.1 christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
70 1.1 christos
71 1.1 christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
72 1.1 christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
73 1.7 christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
74 1.7 christos ((4*4 \
75 1.7 christos + (h != NULL \
76 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
77 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
78 1.7 christos + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
79 1.7 christos & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
80 1.1 christos
81 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
82 1.1 christos
83 1.1 christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
84 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
85 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
86 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
87 1.1 christos {
88 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
89 1.7 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
90 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
91 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
92 1.7 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
93 1.7 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
94 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
95 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 1.1 christos };
97 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
98 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
99 1.1 christos {
100 1.1 christos 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
101 1.1 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
102 1.1 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
103 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
104 1.1 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
105 1.1 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
106 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
107 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 1.1 christos };
109 1.1 christos
110 1.1 christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
111 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
112 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
113 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
114 1.1 christos {
115 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
116 1.7 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
117 1.7 christos 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
118 1.7 christos 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
119 1.7 christos 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
120 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
121 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
122 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 1.1 christos };
124 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
125 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
126 1.1 christos {
127 1.1 christos 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
128 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
129 1.1 christos 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
130 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
131 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 1.1 christos };
136 1.1 christos
137 1.1 christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
138 1.1 christos .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
139 1.1 christos
140 1.1 christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
141 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
142 1.1 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
143 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
144 1.7 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
145 1.1 christos a shared library. */
146 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
147 1.1 christos
148 1.1 christos /* Some instructions. */
149 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
150 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
151 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
152 1.1 christos #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
153 1.1 christos #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
154 1.1 christos #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
155 1.1 christos #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
156 1.1 christos #define B 0x48000000
157 1.3 christos #define BA 0x48000002
158 1.1 christos #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
159 1.1 christos #define BCTR 0x4e800420
160 1.1 christos #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
161 1.1 christos #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
162 1.1 christos #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
163 1.1 christos #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
164 1.1 christos #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
165 1.1 christos #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
166 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
167 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
168 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
169 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
170 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
171 1.1 christos #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
172 1.1 christos #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
173 1.1 christos #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
174 1.1 christos #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
175 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
176 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
177 1.1 christos #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
178 1.1 christos #define NOP 0x60000000
179 1.1 christos #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
180 1.1 christos
181 1.1 christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
182 1.1 christos #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
183 1.1 christos #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
184 1.1 christos
185 1.1 christos /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
186 1.1 christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
187 1.1 christos ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
188 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
189 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
190 1.1 christos
191 1.9 christos /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
193 1.9 christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194 1.9 christos field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195 1.9 christos always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196 1.9 christos PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197 1.9 christos the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198 1.9 christos and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199 1.9 christos rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
200 1.9 christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 1.9 christos complain, special_func) \
202 1.9 christos HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
203 1.10 christos complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
204 1.9 christos #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205 1.1 christos
206 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207 1.1 christos
208 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209 1.10 christos /* This reloc does nothing. */
210 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
211 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212 1.1 christos
213 1.10 christos /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
214 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
215 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216 1.1 christos
217 1.1 christos /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
219 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
220 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221 1.1 christos
222 1.10 christos /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
223 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
224 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225 1.1 christos
226 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
227 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
228 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229 1.1 christos
230 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
231 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
232 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233 1.1 christos
234 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
236 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
237 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238 1.1 christos
239 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
241 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
242 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243 1.1 christos
244 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
246 1.10 christos bits must be zero. */
247 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
248 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249 1.1 christos
250 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
252 1.10 christos two bits must be zero. */
253 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
254 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255 1.1 christos
256 1.10 christos /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
257 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
258 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259 1.1 christos
260 1.10 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
261 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
262 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263 1.1 christos
264 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265 1.1 christos the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
266 1.10 christos zero. */
267 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
268 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269 1.1 christos
270 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271 1.1 christos the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
272 1.10 christos be zero. */
273 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
274 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275 1.1 christos
276 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277 1.10 christos symbol. */
278 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
279 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280 1.1 christos
281 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282 1.10 christos the symbol. */
283 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
284 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285 1.1 christos
286 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287 1.10 christos the symbol. */
288 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
289 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290 1.1 christos
291 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292 1.10 christos the symbol. */
293 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
294 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295 1.1 christos
296 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297 1.10 christos entry for the symbol. */
298 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
299 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300 1.1 christos
301 1.1 christos /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
302 1.1 christos both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
303 1.1 christos dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304 1.1 christos shared library into the object, because the object being
305 1.10 christos run has to have the data at some particular address. */
306 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
307 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308 1.1 christos
309 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310 1.10 christos entries. */
311 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
312 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313 1.1 christos
314 1.10 christos /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
315 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
316 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317 1.1 christos
318 1.1 christos /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
319 1.1 christos longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320 1.10 christos addend. */
321 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
322 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323 1.1 christos
324 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325 1.1 christos object rather than the final value. Normally used for
326 1.10 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
327 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
328 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329 1.1 christos
330 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
331 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
332 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333 1.1 christos
334 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
335 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
336 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337 1.1 christos
338 1.10 christos /* 32-bit PC relative */
339 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
340 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341 1.1 christos
342 1.1 christos /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */
344 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
345 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346 1.1 christos
347 1.1 christos /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */
349 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
350 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351 1.1 christos
352 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353 1.10 christos the symbol. */
354 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
355 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356 1.1 christos
357 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358 1.10 christos the symbol. */
359 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
360 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361 1.1 christos
362 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363 1.10 christos the symbol. */
364 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
365 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366 1.1 christos
367 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368 1.10 christos small data items. */
369 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
370 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371 1.1 christos
372 1.10 christos /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
373 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
374 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375 1.1 christos
376 1.10 christos /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
377 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
378 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379 1.1 christos
380 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
381 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
382 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383 1.1 christos
384 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
385 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
386 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387 1.1 christos
388 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
389 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
390 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391 1.10 christos
392 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
393 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394 1.10 christos
395 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
396 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397 1.7 christos
398 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
399 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
400 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401 1.10 christos
402 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
403 1.7 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404 1.1 christos
405 1.1 christos /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406 1.10 christos definition of its TLS sym. */
407 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
408 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409 1.1 christos
410 1.1 christos /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411 1.1 christos of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412 1.10 christos contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
413 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
414 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415 1.1 christos
416 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
417 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
418 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419 1.1 christos
420 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
421 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
422 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423 1.1 christos
424 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
425 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
426 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427 1.1 christos
428 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
429 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
430 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431 1.1 christos
432 1.1 christos /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433 1.10 christos sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
434 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
435 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436 1.1 christos
437 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
438 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
439 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440 1.1 christos
441 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
442 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
443 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444 1.1 christos
445 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
446 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
447 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448 1.1 christos
449 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
450 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
451 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452 1.1 christos
453 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455 1.10 christos to the first entry. */
456 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
457 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458 1.1 christos
459 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
460 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
461 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462 1.1 christos
463 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
464 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
465 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466 1.1 christos
467 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
468 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
469 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470 1.1 christos
471 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473 1.10 christos first entry. */
474 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
475 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476 1.1 christos
477 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
478 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
479 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480 1.1 christos
481 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
482 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
483 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484 1.1 christos
485 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
486 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
487 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488 1.1 christos
489 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490 1.10 christos the offset to the entry. */
491 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
492 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493 1.1 christos
494 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
495 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
496 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497 1.1 christos
498 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
499 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
500 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501 1.1 christos
502 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
503 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
504 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505 1.1 christos
506 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507 1.10 christos offset to the entry. */
508 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
509 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510 1.1 christos
511 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
512 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
513 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514 1.1 christos
515 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
516 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
517 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518 1.1 christos
519 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
520 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
521 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522 1.1 christos
523 1.1 christos /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524 1.1 christos in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
525 1.1 christos
526 1.10 christos /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
527 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
528 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529 1.1 christos
530 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
531 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
532 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533 1.1 christos
534 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
535 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
536 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537 1.1 christos
538 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
539 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
540 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541 1.1 christos
542 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543 1.1 christos plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544 1.10 christos is negative. */
545 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
546 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547 1.1 christos
548 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549 1.1 christos address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550 1.10 christos _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
551 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
552 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553 1.1 christos
554 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555 1.1 christos address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556 1.10 christos _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
557 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
558 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559 1.1 christos
560 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561 1.10 christos small data items. */
562 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
563 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564 1.1 christos
565 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566 1.1 christos signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567 1.10 christos field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
568 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
569 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570 1.1 christos
571 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577 1.1 christos
578 1.1 christos /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579 1.1 christos in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580 1.10 christos register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
581 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
582 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583 1.1 christos
584 1.10 christos /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
585 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
586 1.3 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587 1.1 christos
588 1.10 christos /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
589 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
590 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591 1.3 christos
592 1.10 christos /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
593 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
594 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595 1.1 christos
596 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
597 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
598 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599 1.1 christos
600 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
601 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
602 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603 1.1 christos
604 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
605 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
606 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607 1.1 christos
608 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
609 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
610 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611 1.1 christos
612 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
613 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
614 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615 1.1 christos
616 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
617 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
618 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619 1.3 christos
620 1.3 christos /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621 1.3 christos instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622 1.10 christos the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
623 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
624 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625 1.3 christos
626 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
627 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
628 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629 1.1 christos
630 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
631 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
632 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633 1.1 christos
634 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
635 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
636 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637 1.1 christos
638 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
639 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
640 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641 1.1 christos
642 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
643 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
644 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645 1.1 christos
646 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
647 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
648 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649 1.1 christos
650 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
651 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
652 1.7 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653 1.7 christos
654 1.10 christos /* e_li split20 format. */
655 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
656 1.9 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657 1.10 christos
658 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
659 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660 1.1 christos
661 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
662 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
663 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664 1.1 christos
665 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
666 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
667 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668 1.1 christos
669 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
670 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
671 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672 1.1 christos
673 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
675 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
676 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677 1.3 christos
678 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
679 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
680 1.3 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681 1.7 christos
682 1.10 christos /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
683 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
684 1.7 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685 1.1 christos
686 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
687 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
688 1.1 christos NULL),
689 1.1 christos
690 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
691 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
692 1.1 christos NULL),
693 1.1 christos
694 1.10 christos /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
695 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
696 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 1.1 christos };
698 1.1 christos
699 1.1 christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
701 1.1 christos
702 1.1 christos static void
703 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
704 1.1 christos {
705 1.1 christos unsigned int i, type;
706 1.1 christos
707 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
708 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
709 1.1 christos i++)
710 1.1 christos {
711 1.1 christos type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
712 1.1 christos if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
713 1.1 christos / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
714 1.1 christos abort ();
715 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
716 1.1 christos }
717 1.1 christos }
718 1.1 christos
719 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
720 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
721 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
722 1.1 christos {
723 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
724 1.1 christos
725 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
726 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
727 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
728 1.1 christos
729 1.1 christos switch (code)
730 1.1 christos {
731 1.1 christos default:
732 1.1 christos return NULL;
733 1.1 christos
734 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
735 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
736 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
737 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
738 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
739 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
740 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
741 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
742 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
743 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
744 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
747 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
748 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
749 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
750 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
751 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
752 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
753 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
754 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
755 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
756 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
757 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
758 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
759 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
760 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
761 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
762 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
763 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
764 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
765 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
766 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
767 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
768 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
769 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
770 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
771 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
772 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
773 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
774 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
775 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
776 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
777 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
778 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
779 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
780 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
781 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
782 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
783 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
784 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
785 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
786 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
787 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
788 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
789 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
790 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
791 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
792 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
793 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
794 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
795 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
796 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
797 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
798 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
799 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
800 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
801 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
802 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
803 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
804 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
805 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
806 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
807 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
808 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
809 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
810 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
811 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
812 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
813 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
814 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
815 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
816 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
817 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
818 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
819 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
820 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
821 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
822 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
823 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
824 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
825 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
826 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
827 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
828 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
829 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
830 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
831 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
832 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
833 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
834 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
835 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
836 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
837 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
838 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
839 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
840 1.1 christos break;
841 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
842 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
843 1.1 christos break;
844 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
845 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
846 1.1 christos break;
847 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
848 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
849 1.1 christos break;
850 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
851 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
852 1.1 christos break;
853 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
854 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
855 1.1 christos break;
856 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
857 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
858 1.7 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
859 1.3 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
860 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
861 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
862 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
863 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
864 1.1 christos }
865 1.1 christos
866 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
867 1.1 christos };
868 1.1 christos
869 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
870 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
871 1.1 christos const char *r_name)
872 1.1 christos {
873 1.1 christos unsigned int i;
874 1.1 christos
875 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
876 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
877 1.1 christos i++)
878 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
879 1.1 christos && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
880 1.1 christos return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
881 1.1 christos
882 1.1 christos return NULL;
883 1.1 christos }
884 1.1 christos
885 1.10 christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
886 1.7 christos
887 1.1 christos static bool
888 1.1 christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
889 1.1 christos arelent *cache_ptr,
890 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
891 1.3 christos {
892 1.1 christos unsigned int r_type;
893 1.1 christos
894 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
895 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
896 1.3 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
897 1.3 christos
898 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
899 1.7 christos if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
900 1.7 christos {
901 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
902 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
903 1.10 christos abfd, r_type);
904 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
905 1.7 christos return false;
906 1.3 christos }
907 1.1 christos
908 1.1 christos cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
909 1.1 christos
910 1.7 christos /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
911 1.1 christos ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
912 1.7 christos if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
913 1.7 christos {
914 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
915 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
916 1.1 christos abfd, r_type);
917 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
918 1.1 christos
919 1.7 christos return false;
920 1.10 christos }
921 1.1 christos
922 1.1 christos return true;
923 1.1 christos }
924 1.1 christos
925 1.1 christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
926 1.7 christos
927 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
928 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
929 1.7 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
930 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
931 1.1 christos void *data,
932 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
933 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
934 1.3 christos char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
935 1.3 christos {
936 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
937 1.3 christos long insn;
938 1.1 christos bfd_size_type octets;
939 1.1 christos bfd_vma value;
940 1.1 christos
941 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
942 1.1 christos {
943 1.1 christos reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
944 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
945 1.3 christos }
946 1.3 christos
947 1.3 christos reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
948 1.3 christos r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
949 1.3 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
950 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_continue;
951 1.3 christos
952 1.3 christos value = 0;
953 1.3 christos if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
954 1.3 christos value = symbol->value;
955 1.3 christos value += (reloc_entry->addend
956 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_offset
957 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
958 1.3 christos value -= (reloc_entry->address
959 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset
960 1.3 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
961 1.9 christos value >>= 16;
962 1.10 christos
963 1.10 christos octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
964 1.10 christos if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
965 1.10 christos input_section, octets))
966 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
967 1.3 christos
968 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
969 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
970 1.3 christos insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
971 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
972 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
973 1.1 christos }
974 1.1 christos
975 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
976 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
977 1.1 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
978 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
979 1.1 christos void *data,
980 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
981 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
982 1.1 christos char **error_message)
983 1.1 christos {
984 1.1 christos /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
985 1.1 christos call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
986 1.1 christos link time. */
987 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
988 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
989 1.1 christos input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
990 1.1 christos
991 1.10 christos if (error_message != NULL)
992 1.10 christos {
993 1.10 christos static char *message;
994 1.10 christos free (message);
995 1.10 christos if (asprintf (&message, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
996 1.10 christos reloc_entry->howto->name) < 0)
997 1.1 christos message = NULL;
998 1.1 christos *error_message = message;
999 1.1 christos }
1000 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1001 1.1 christos }
1002 1.1 christos
1003 1.1 christos /* Sections created by the linker. */
1005 1.1 christos
1006 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
1007 1.1 christos {
1008 1.1 christos /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1009 1.1 christos asection *section;
1010 1.1 christos /* Section name. */
1011 1.1 christos const char *name;
1012 1.1 christos /* Associated bss section name. */
1013 1.1 christos const char *bss_name;
1014 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol name. */
1015 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
1016 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol. */
1017 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1018 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_t;
1019 1.1 christos
1020 1.1 christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1021 1.1 christos symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1022 1.1 christos based on different addend's. */
1023 1.1 christos
1024 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1025 1.1 christos {
1026 1.1 christos /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1027 1.1 christos struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1028 1.1 christos /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1029 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
1030 1.1 christos /* addend used */
1031 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
1032 1.1 christos /* which linker section this is */
1033 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1034 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1035 1.1 christos
1036 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1037 1.1 christos {
1038 1.1 christos struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1039 1.1 christos
1040 1.1 christos /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1041 1.1 christos sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1042 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1043 1.1 christos
1044 1.1 christos /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1045 1.1 christos unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1046 1.1 christos unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1047 1.1 christos };
1048 1.1 christos
1049 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1050 1.1 christos ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1051 1.1 christos
1052 1.1 christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1053 1.1 christos (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1054 1.1 christos
1055 1.1 christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1056 1.1 christos (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1057 1.1 christos && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1058 1.10 christos
1059 1.1 christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1060 1.1 christos
1061 1.1 christos static bool
1062 1.1 christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1063 1.1 christos {
1064 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1065 1.6 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1066 1.6 christos }
1067 1.10 christos
1068 1.6 christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1069 1.6 christos
1070 1.6 christos bool
1071 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1072 1.6 christos {
1073 1.6 christos unsigned long mach = 0;
1074 1.6 christos asection *s;
1075 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents;
1076 1.6 christos
1077 1.6 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1078 1.6 christos && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1079 1.6 christos {
1080 1.6 christos
1081 1.6 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1082 1.6 christos if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1083 1.6 christos break;
1084 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
1085 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1086 1.6 christos }
1087 1.6 christos
1088 1.9 christos if (mach == 0)
1089 1.9 christos {
1090 1.9 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1091 1.6 christos if (s != NULL
1092 1.6 christos && s->size >= 24
1093 1.6 christos && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1094 1.6 christos {
1095 1.6 christos unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1096 1.6 christos unsigned int i;
1097 1.6 christos
1098 1.6 christos for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1099 1.6 christos {
1100 1.6 christos unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1101 1.6 christos switch (val >> 16)
1102 1.6 christos {
1103 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1104 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1105 1.6 christos if (mach == 0)
1106 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1107 1.6 christos break;
1108 1.6 christos
1109 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1110 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1111 1.6 christos if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1112 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1113 1.6 christos break;
1114 1.6 christos
1115 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1116 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1117 1.7 christos case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1118 1.6 christos if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1119 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1120 1.6 christos break;
1121 1.6 christos
1122 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1123 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1124 1.6 christos break;
1125 1.6 christos
1126 1.6 christos default:
1127 1.6 christos mach = -1ul;
1128 1.6 christos }
1129 1.6 christos }
1130 1.6 christos free (contents);
1131 1.6 christos }
1132 1.6 christos }
1133 1.6 christos
1134 1.6 christos if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1135 1.6 christos {
1136 1.6 christos const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1137 1.6 christos
1138 1.6 christos for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1139 1.6 christos if (arch->mach == mach)
1140 1.6 christos {
1141 1.6 christos abfd->arch_info = arch;
1142 1.10 christos break;
1143 1.6 christos }
1144 1.6 christos }
1145 1.1 christos return true;
1146 1.6 christos }
1147 1.1 christos
1148 1.10 christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1149 1.1 christos default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1150 1.1 christos
1151 1.6 christos static bool
1152 1.10 christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1153 1.6 christos {
1154 1.6 christos if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1155 1.1 christos return true;
1156 1.1 christos
1157 1.1 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1158 1.1 christos {
1159 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1160 1.1 christos
1161 1.1 christos if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1162 1.1 christos {
1163 1.1 christos /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1164 1.1 christos abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1165 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1166 1.1 christos }
1167 1.1 christos }
1168 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1169 1.1 christos }
1170 1.10 christos
1171 1.1 christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1172 1.1 christos
1173 1.1 christos static bool
1174 1.1 christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1175 1.1 christos {
1176 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1177 1.10 christos || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1178 1.10 christos
1179 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1180 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
1181 1.1 christos return true;
1182 1.1 christos }
1183 1.10 christos
1184 1.1 christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1185 1.1 christos
1186 1.1 christos static bool
1187 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1188 1.1 christos {
1189 1.1 christos int offset;
1190 1.1 christos unsigned int size;
1191 1.1 christos
1192 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz)
1193 1.1 christos {
1194 1.1 christos default:
1195 1.1 christos return false;
1196 1.3 christos
1197 1.1 christos case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1198 1.1 christos /* pr_cursig */
1199 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1200 1.1 christos
1201 1.1 christos /* pr_pid */
1202 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1203 1.1 christos
1204 1.1 christos /* pr_reg */
1205 1.1 christos offset = 72;
1206 1.1 christos size = 192;
1207 1.1 christos
1208 1.1 christos break;
1209 1.1 christos }
1210 1.1 christos
1211 1.1 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1212 1.1 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1213 1.10 christos size, note->descpos + offset);
1214 1.1 christos }
1215 1.1 christos
1216 1.1 christos static bool
1217 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1218 1.1 christos {
1219 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz)
1220 1.1 christos {
1221 1.1 christos default:
1222 1.3 christos return false;
1223 1.1 christos
1224 1.3 christos case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1225 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1226 1.3 christos = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1227 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1228 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1229 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1230 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1231 1.1 christos }
1232 1.1 christos
1233 1.1 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1234 1.1 christos onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1235 1.3 christos implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1236 1.1 christos
1237 1.1 christos {
1238 1.1 christos char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1239 1.1 christos int n = strlen (command);
1240 1.1 christos
1241 1.1 christos if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1242 1.10 christos command[n - 1] = '\0';
1243 1.1 christos }
1244 1.1 christos
1245 1.1 christos return true;
1246 1.1 christos }
1247 1.1 christos
1248 1.1 christos static char *
1249 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1250 1.1 christos {
1251 1.1 christos switch (note_type)
1252 1.1 christos {
1253 1.1 christos default:
1254 1.1 christos return NULL;
1255 1.7 christos
1256 1.1 christos case NT_PRPSINFO:
1257 1.1 christos {
1258 1.1 christos char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1259 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1260 1.1 christos
1261 1.9 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1262 1.7 christos memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1263 1.9 christos strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1264 1.7 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1265 1.7 christos DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1266 1.7 christos /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1267 1.7 christos -Wstringop-truncation:
1268 1.7 christos https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1269 1.1 christos */
1270 1.9 christos DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1271 1.7 christos #endif
1272 1.7 christos strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1273 1.1 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1274 1.1 christos DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1275 1.1 christos #endif
1276 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1277 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1278 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1279 1.1 christos }
1280 1.1 christos
1281 1.1 christos case NT_PRSTATUS:
1282 1.1 christos {
1283 1.1 christos char data[268];
1284 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1285 1.1 christos long pid;
1286 1.1 christos int cursig;
1287 1.1 christos const void *greg;
1288 1.1 christos
1289 1.1 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1290 1.1 christos memset (data, 0, 72);
1291 1.1 christos pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1292 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1293 1.1 christos cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1294 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1295 1.1 christos greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1296 1.1 christos memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1297 1.1 christos memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1298 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1299 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1300 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1301 1.1 christos }
1302 1.1 christos }
1303 1.3 christos }
1304 1.1 christos
1305 1.1 christos static flagword
1306 1.1 christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1307 1.1 christos {
1308 1.1 christos
1309 1.1 christos if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1310 1.1 christos return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1311 1.1 christos
1312 1.1 christos return 0;
1313 1.1 christos }
1314 1.1 christos
1315 1.1 christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1316 1.1 christos or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1317 1.1 christos
1318 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
1319 1.1 christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1320 1.1 christos const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1321 1.1 christos const arelent *rel)
1322 1.1 christos {
1323 1.1 christos return rel->address;
1324 1.1 christos }
1325 1.1 christos
1326 1.1 christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1327 1.10 christos is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1328 1.1 christos type. */
1329 1.1 christos
1330 1.1 christos static bool
1331 1.1 christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1332 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1333 1.1 christos const char *name,
1334 1.1 christos int shindex)
1335 1.1 christos {
1336 1.1 christos asection *newsect;
1337 1.10 christos flagword flags;
1338 1.1 christos
1339 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1340 1.10 christos return false;
1341 1.1 christos
1342 1.1 christos newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1343 1.1 christos flags = 0;
1344 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1345 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1346 1.1 christos
1347 1.10 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1348 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1349 1.10 christos
1350 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
1351 1.10 christos name += 8;
1352 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
1353 1.10 christos || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
1354 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1355 1.1 christos
1356 1.1 christos return (flags == 0
1357 1.1 christos || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1358 1.1 christos }
1359 1.10 christos
1360 1.1 christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1361 1.1 christos
1362 1.1 christos static bool
1363 1.1 christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1364 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1365 1.1 christos asection *asect)
1366 1.1 christos {
1367 1.10 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1368 1.1 christos shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1369 1.1 christos
1370 1.1 christos return true;
1371 1.1 christos }
1372 1.1 christos
1373 1.1 christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1374 1.1 christos need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1375 1.1 christos
1376 1.1 christos static int
1377 1.1 christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1378 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1379 1.1 christos {
1380 1.1 christos asection *s;
1381 1.1 christos int ret = 0;
1382 1.1 christos
1383 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1384 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1385 1.1 christos ++ret;
1386 1.1 christos
1387 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1388 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1389 1.1 christos ++ret;
1390 1.1 christos
1391 1.3 christos return ret;
1392 1.1 christos }
1393 1.10 christos
1394 1.1 christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1395 1.1 christos
1396 1.1 christos bool
1397 1.7 christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1398 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1399 1.1 christos {
1400 1.1 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
1401 1.1 christos
1402 1.1 christos /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1403 1.1 christos LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1404 1.1 christos there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1405 1.3 christos If we find that case, we split the segment.
1406 1.1 christos We maintain the original output section order. */
1407 1.7 christos
1408 1.10 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1409 1.7 christos {
1410 1.7 christos struct elf_segment_map *n;
1411 1.7 christos size_t amt;
1412 1.7 christos unsigned int j, k;
1413 1.1 christos unsigned int p_flags;
1414 1.1 christos
1415 1.7 christos if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1416 1.1 christos continue;
1417 1.7 christos
1418 1.7 christos for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1419 1.7 christos {
1420 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1421 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_W;
1422 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1423 1.7 christos {
1424 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_X;
1425 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1427 1.7 christos break;
1428 1.7 christos }
1429 1.7 christos }
1430 1.7 christos if (j != m->count)
1431 1.1 christos while (++j != m->count)
1432 1.7 christos {
1433 1.7 christos unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1434 1.7 christos
1435 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1436 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1437 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1438 1.7 christos {
1439 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1440 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1441 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1442 1.7 christos if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1443 1.7 christos break;
1444 1.7 christos }
1445 1.7 christos p_flags |= p_flags1;
1446 1.7 christos }
1447 1.7 christos /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1448 1.7 christos sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1449 1.7 christos two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1450 1.7 christos are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1451 1.7 christos if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1452 1.7 christos {
1453 1.7 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1454 1.1 christos m->p_flags = p_flags;
1455 1.1 christos }
1456 1.7 christos if (j == m->count)
1457 1.1 christos continue;
1458 1.1 christos
1459 1.1 christos /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1460 1.1 christos the remainder are put in a new segment.
1461 1.1 christos The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1462 1.1 christos
1463 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1464 1.10 christos amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1465 1.1 christos n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1466 1.1 christos if (n == NULL)
1467 1.1 christos return false;
1468 1.1 christos
1469 1.7 christos n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1470 1.7 christos n->count = m->count - j;
1471 1.7 christos for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1472 1.1 christos n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1473 1.1 christos m->count = j;
1474 1.1 christos m->p_size_valid = 0;
1475 1.1 christos n->next = m->next;
1476 1.10 christos m->next = n;
1477 1.1 christos }
1478 1.1 christos
1479 1.1 christos return true;
1480 1.1 christos }
1481 1.1 christos
1482 1.1 christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1483 1.1 christos .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1484 1.1 christos that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1485 1.1 christos 2 sections. */
1486 1.6 christos
1487 1.6 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1488 1.6 christos {
1489 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1490 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1491 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1492 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1493 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1494 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1495 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1496 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1497 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1498 1.1 christos { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1499 1.10 christos };
1500 1.7 christos
1501 1.1 christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1502 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1503 1.7 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1504 1.1 christos
1505 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1506 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1507 1.1 christos {
1508 1.1 christos const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1509 1.1 christos
1510 1.1 christos /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1511 1.1 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
1512 1.1 christos return NULL;
1513 1.1 christos
1514 1.1 christos ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1515 1.1 christos sec->use_rela_p);
1516 1.1 christos if (ssect != NULL)
1517 1.1 christos {
1518 1.1 christos if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1519 1.1 christos ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1520 1.1 christos return ssect;
1521 1.1 christos }
1522 1.1 christos
1523 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1524 1.1 christos }
1525 1.1 christos
1526 1.1 christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1528 1.1 christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
1529 1.1 christos {
1530 1.1 christos struct apuinfo_list *next;
1531 1.1 christos unsigned long value;
1532 1.10 christos }
1533 1.1 christos apuinfo_list;
1534 1.1 christos
1535 1.1 christos static apuinfo_list *head;
1536 1.1 christos static bool apuinfo_set;
1537 1.1 christos
1538 1.10 christos static void
1539 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
1540 1.1 christos {
1541 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1542 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = false;
1543 1.1 christos }
1544 1.1 christos
1545 1.1 christos static void
1546 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1547 1.1 christos {
1548 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1549 1.1 christos
1550 1.1 christos while (entry != NULL)
1551 1.1 christos {
1552 1.1 christos if (entry->value == value)
1553 1.1 christos return;
1554 1.1 christos entry = entry->next;
1555 1.1 christos }
1556 1.1 christos
1557 1.1 christos entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1558 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
1559 1.1 christos return;
1560 1.1 christos
1561 1.1 christos entry->value = value;
1562 1.1 christos entry->next = head;
1563 1.1 christos head = entry;
1564 1.1 christos }
1565 1.1 christos
1566 1.1 christos static unsigned
1567 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
1568 1.1 christos {
1569 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1570 1.1 christos unsigned long count;
1571 1.1 christos
1572 1.1 christos for (entry = head, count = 0;
1573 1.1 christos entry;
1574 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1575 1.1 christos ++ count;
1576 1.1 christos
1577 1.1 christos return count;
1578 1.1 christos }
1579 1.1 christos
1580 1.1 christos static inline unsigned long
1581 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1582 1.1 christos {
1583 1.1 christos apuinfo_list * entry;
1584 1.1 christos
1585 1.1 christos for (entry = head;
1586 1.1 christos entry && number --;
1587 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1588 1.1 christos ;
1589 1.1 christos
1590 1.1 christos return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1591 1.1 christos }
1592 1.1 christos
1593 1.1 christos static void
1594 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1595 1.1 christos {
1596 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1597 1.1 christos
1598 1.1 christos for (entry = head; entry;)
1599 1.1 christos {
1600 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1601 1.1 christos free (entry);
1602 1.1 christos entry = next;
1603 1.1 christos }
1604 1.1 christos
1605 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1606 1.1 christos }
1607 1.1 christos
1608 1.1 christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1609 1.1 christos the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1610 1.1 christos
1611 1.1 christos static void
1612 1.1 christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1613 1.1 christos {
1614 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
1615 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1616 1.1 christos char *buffer = NULL;
1617 1.1 christos bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1618 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1619 1.1 christos unsigned long length;
1620 1.1 christos const char *error_message = NULL;
1621 1.1 christos
1622 1.1 christos if (link_info == NULL)
1623 1.1 christos return;
1624 1.3 christos
1625 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init ();
1626 1.1 christos
1627 1.1 christos /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1628 1.1 christos for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1629 1.1 christos {
1630 1.1 christos unsigned long datum;
1631 1.1 christos
1632 1.7 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1633 1.7 christos if (asec == NULL)
1634 1.1 christos continue;
1635 1.1 christos
1636 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1637 1.1 christos error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1638 1.10 christos length = asec->size;
1639 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1640 1.1 christos goto fail;
1641 1.10 christos
1642 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = true;
1643 1.1 christos if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1644 1.1 christos {
1645 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1646 1.1 christos largest_input_size = asec->size;
1647 1.1 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1648 1.1 christos if (!buffer)
1649 1.1 christos return;
1650 1.1 christos }
1651 1.7 christos
1652 1.7 christos if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1653 1.1 christos || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1654 1.1 christos {
1655 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1656 1.1 christos error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1657 1.1 christos goto fail;
1658 1.1 christos }
1659 1.1 christos
1660 1.1 christos /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1661 1.1 christos extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1662 1.1 christos host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1663 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1664 1.1 christos if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1665 1.1 christos goto fail;
1666 1.1 christos
1667 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1668 1.1 christos if (datum != 0x2)
1669 1.1 christos goto fail;
1670 1.1 christos
1671 1.1 christos if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1672 1.1 christos goto fail;
1673 1.1 christos
1674 1.1 christos /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1675 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1676 1.1 christos if (datum + 20 != length)
1677 1.1 christos goto fail;
1678 1.1 christos
1679 1.1 christos /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1680 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1681 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1682 1.1 christos }
1683 1.1 christos
1684 1.1 christos error_message = NULL;
1685 1.1 christos
1686 1.1 christos if (apuinfo_set)
1687 1.1 christos {
1688 1.1 christos /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1689 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1690 1.9 christos
1691 1.1 christos /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1692 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1693 1.7 christos
1694 1.7 christos if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1695 1.1 christos {
1696 1.1 christos ibfd = abfd;
1697 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1698 1.1 christos error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1699 1.10 christos }
1700 1.1 christos }
1701 1.1 christos
1702 1.7 christos fail:
1703 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1704 1.1 christos
1705 1.1 christos if (error_message)
1706 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1707 1.1 christos }
1708 1.10 christos
1709 1.1 christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1710 1.1 christos contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1711 1.1 christos
1712 1.1 christos static bool
1713 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1714 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1715 1.1 christos asection *asec,
1716 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1717 1.1 christos {
1718 1.1 christos return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1719 1.1 christos }
1720 1.9 christos
1721 1.1 christos /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1722 1.1 christos
1723 1.1 christos static void
1724 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1725 1.1 christos {
1726 1.1 christos bfd_byte *buffer;
1727 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1728 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1729 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries;
1730 1.1 christos bfd_size_type length;
1731 1.1 christos
1732 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1733 1.1 christos if (asec == NULL)
1734 1.1 christos return;
1735 1.1 christos
1736 1.1 christos if (!apuinfo_set)
1737 1.1 christos return;
1738 1.1 christos
1739 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1740 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1741 1.1 christos return;
1742 1.7 christos
1743 1.7 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1744 1.1 christos if (buffer == NULL)
1745 1.1 christos {
1746 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
1747 1.1 christos (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1748 1.1 christos return;
1749 1.1 christos }
1750 1.1 christos
1751 1.1 christos /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1752 1.1 christos num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1753 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1754 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1755 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1756 1.1 christos strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1757 1.1 christos
1758 1.1 christos length = 20;
1759 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1760 1.1 christos {
1761 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1762 1.7 christos length += 4;
1763 1.1 christos }
1764 1.1 christos
1765 1.7 christos if (length != asec->size)
1766 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1767 1.1 christos
1768 1.1 christos if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1769 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1770 1.1 christos
1771 1.9 christos free (buffer);
1772 1.10 christos
1773 1.9 christos apuinfo_list_finish ();
1774 1.9 christos }
1775 1.9 christos
1776 1.9 christos static bool
1777 1.9 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1778 1.1 christos {
1779 1.10 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1780 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1781 1.1 christos }
1782 1.7 christos
1783 1.1 christos static bool
1785 1.10 christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1786 1.1 christos {
1787 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1788 1.1 christos
1789 1.1 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1790 1.1 christos return false;
1791 1.1 christos
1792 1.1 christos return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1793 1.10 christos && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1794 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1795 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1796 1.1 christos }
1797 1.1 christos
1798 1.1 christos static bool
1799 1.1 christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1800 1.1 christos {
1801 1.1 christos bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1802 1.1 christos return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1803 1.1 christos && section->vma <= vma
1804 1.1 christos && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1805 1.1 christos }
1806 1.1 christos
1807 1.10 christos static long
1808 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1809 1.1 christos long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1810 1.1 christos asymbol **ret)
1811 1.7 christos {
1812 1.1 christos bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
1813 1.1 christos asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1814 1.9 christos bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1815 1.1 christos bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1816 1.1 christos bfd_vma stub_off;
1817 1.1 christos asymbol *s;
1818 1.1 christos arelent *p;
1819 1.1 christos size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1820 1.1 christos size_t size;
1821 1.1 christos char *names;
1822 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4];
1823 1.1 christos
1824 1.1 christos *ret = NULL;
1825 1.1 christos
1826 1.1 christos if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1827 1.1 christos return 0;
1828 1.1 christos
1829 1.1 christos if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1830 1.1 christos return 0;
1831 1.1 christos
1832 1.1 christos relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1833 1.1 christos if (relplt == NULL)
1834 1.1 christos return 0;
1835 1.1 christos
1836 1.1 christos plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1837 1.1 christos if (plt == NULL)
1838 1.1 christos return 0;
1839 1.1 christos
1840 1.1 christos /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1841 1.1 christos if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1842 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1843 1.1 christos dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1844 1.1 christos
1845 1.1 christos /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1846 1.1 christos of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1847 1.1 christos dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1848 1.1 christos if (dynamic != NULL)
1849 1.1 christos {
1850 1.1 christos bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1851 1.1 christos size_t extdynsize;
1852 1.1 christos void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1853 1.1 christos
1854 1.1 christos if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1855 1.1 christos return -1;
1856 1.1 christos
1857 1.1 christos extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1858 1.1 christos swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1859 1.1 christos
1860 1.1 christos extdyn = dynbuf;
1861 1.1 christos extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1862 1.1 christos for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1863 1.1 christos {
1864 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1865 1.1 christos (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1866 1.1 christos
1867 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1868 1.1 christos break;
1869 1.1 christos
1870 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1871 1.1 christos {
1872 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1873 1.1 christos asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1874 1.1 christos if (got != NULL
1875 1.1 christos && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1876 1.1 christos g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1877 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1878 1.1 christos break;
1879 1.1 christos }
1880 1.1 christos }
1881 1.1 christos free (dynbuf);
1882 1.1 christos }
1883 1.1 christos
1884 1.1 christos /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1885 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1886 1.1 christos {
1887 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1888 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1889 1.1 christos }
1890 1.1 christos
1891 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1892 1.1 christos return 0;
1893 1.1 christos
1894 1.1 christos /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1895 1.1 christos link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1896 1.1 christos glink stubs now reside. */
1897 1.1 christos glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1898 1.1 christos if (glink == NULL)
1899 1.1 christos return 0;
1900 1.1 christos
1901 1.1 christos /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1902 1.1 christos from the first glink stub. */
1903 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1904 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1905 1.1 christos {
1906 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1907 1.1 christos
1908 1.1 christos /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1909 1.1 christos insn ^= B;
1910 1.1 christos if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1911 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1912 1.1 christos
1913 1.1 christos /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1914 1.1 christos else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1915 1.1 christos for (i = 4;
1916 1.1 christos bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1917 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1918 1.1 christos i += 4)
1919 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1920 1.1 christos {
1921 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1922 1.1 christos break;
1923 1.1 christos }
1924 1.1 christos }
1925 1.7 christos
1926 1.7 christos count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1927 1.7 christos /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1928 1.7 christos multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1929 1.7 christos there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1930 1.7 christos of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1931 1.7 christos The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1932 1.7 christos GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1933 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1934 1.1 christos for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1935 1.1 christos if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1936 1.10 christos break;
1937 1.1 christos if (stub_delta > 32)
1938 1.1 christos return 0;
1939 1.1 christos
1940 1.1 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1941 1.1 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
1942 1.1 christos return -1;
1943 1.1 christos
1944 1.1 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1945 1.1 christos p = relplt->relocation;
1946 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1947 1.1 christos {
1948 1.1 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1949 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1950 1.1 christos size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1951 1.1 christos }
1952 1.1 christos
1953 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1954 1.1 christos
1955 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
1956 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1957 1.7 christos
1958 1.1 christos s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1959 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
1960 1.3 christos return -1;
1961 1.1 christos
1962 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1963 1.1 christos names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1964 1.7 christos p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1965 1.7 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1966 1.7 christos {
1967 1.1 christos size_t len;
1968 1.1 christos
1969 1.1 christos stub_off -= stub_delta;
1970 1.1 christos if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1971 1.1 christos stub_off -= 32;
1972 1.1 christos *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1973 1.1 christos /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1974 1.7 christos we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1975 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1976 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1977 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1978 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1979 1.1 christos s->value = stub_off;
1980 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1981 1.1 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
1982 1.1 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1983 1.1 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1984 1.1 christos names += len;
1985 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1986 1.1 christos {
1987 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1988 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1989 1.1 christos bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1990 1.3 christos names += strlen (names);
1991 1.1 christos }
1992 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1993 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("@plt");
1994 1.1 christos ++s;
1995 1.1 christos --p;
1996 1.1 christos }
1997 1.1 christos
1998 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1999 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2000 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
2001 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2002 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
2003 1.1 christos s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2004 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2005 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
2006 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink");
2007 1.1 christos s++;
2008 1.1 christos count++;
2009 1.1 christos
2010 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
2011 1.1 christos {
2012 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
2013 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2014 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
2015 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2016 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
2017 1.1 christos s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2018 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2019 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2020 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2021 1.1 christos s++;
2022 1.1 christos count++;
2023 1.1 christos }
2024 1.1 christos
2025 1.1 christos return count;
2026 1.1 christos }
2027 1.1 christos
2028 1.1 christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2030 1.1 christos functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2031 1.1 christos or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2032 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2033 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2034 1.1 christos called. */
2035 1.1 christos
2036 1.1 christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2037 1.1 christos than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2038 1.1 christos struct plt_entry
2039 1.1 christos {
2040 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *next;
2041 1.1 christos
2042 1.1 christos /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2043 1.1 christos This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2044 1.1 christos GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2045 1.1 christos gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2046 1.1 christos sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2047 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2048 1.1 christos
2049 1.1 christos /* The .got2 section. */
2050 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2051 1.1 christos
2052 1.1 christos /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2053 1.1 christos union
2054 1.1 christos {
2055 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2056 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2057 1.7 christos } plt;
2058 1.7 christos
2059 1.7 christos /* .glink stub offset. */
2060 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_offset;
2061 1.1 christos };
2062 1.1 christos
2063 1.1 christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2064 1.1 christos function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2065 1.1 christos library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2066 1.1 christos
2067 1.1 christos static int
2068 1.7 christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2069 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2070 1.7 christos {
2071 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
2072 1.1 christos {
2073 1.1 christos default:
2074 1.1 christos /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2075 1.1 christos address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2076 1.1 christos dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2077 1.1 christos local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2078 1.1 christos return 1;
2079 1.1 christos
2080 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
2081 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
2082 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2083 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
2085 1.1 christos return 0;
2086 1.7 christos
2087 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2088 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2089 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2090 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2091 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2092 1.1 christos /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2093 1.1 christos linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2094 1.1 christos return bfd_link_dll (info);
2095 1.1 christos }
2096 1.1 christos }
2097 1.1 christos
2098 1.3 christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2099 1.3 christos copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2100 1.3 christos section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2101 1.3 christos shared lib. */
2102 1.3 christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2103 1.3 christos
2104 1.3 christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2105 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2106 1.3 christos {
2107 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2108 1.3 christos
2109 1.3 christos /* The input section of the reloc. */
2110 1.3 christos asection *sec;
2111 1.3 christos
2112 1.3 christos /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2113 1.1 christos unsigned int count : 31;
2114 1.1 christos
2115 1.1 christos /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2116 1.1 christos unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2117 1.1 christos };
2118 1.1 christos
2119 1.1 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2120 1.1 christos
2121 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2122 1.1 christos {
2123 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2124 1.7 christos
2125 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2126 1.7 christos specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2127 1.7 christos from the beginning of the section. */
2128 1.7 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2129 1.7 christos
2130 1.9 christos /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2131 1.7 christos Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2132 1.7 christos encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2133 1.7 christos of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2134 1.7 christos optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2135 1.7 christos needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2136 1.7 christos set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2137 1.7 christos These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2138 1.9 christos #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2139 1.7 christos #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2140 1.7 christos #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2141 1.7 christos #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2142 1.7 christos #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2143 1.7 christos #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2144 1.7 christos #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2145 1.7 christos unsigned char tls_mask;
2146 1.1 christos
2147 1.1 christos /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2148 1.1 christos case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2149 1.3 christos #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2150 1.3 christos #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2151 1.3 christos #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2152 1.3 christos
2153 1.3 christos /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2154 1.1 christos symbol. */
2155 1.1 christos unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2156 1.1 christos
2157 1.1 christos /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2158 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2159 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2160 1.1 christos };
2161 1.1 christos
2162 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2163 1.1 christos
2164 1.3 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2165 1.3 christos
2166 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2167 1.1 christos {
2168 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2169 1.1 christos
2170 1.1 christos /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2171 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2172 1.1 christos
2173 1.1 christos /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2174 1.7 christos asection *glink;
2175 1.7 christos asection *dynsbss;
2176 1.1 christos asection *relsbss;
2177 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2178 1.1 christos asection *sbss;
2179 1.1 christos asection *glink_eh_frame;
2180 1.1 christos asection *pltlocal;
2181 1.1 christos asection *relpltlocal;
2182 1.1 christos
2183 1.1 christos /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2184 1.1 christos asection *srelplt2;
2185 1.1 christos
2186 1.1 christos /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2187 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2188 1.1 christos
2189 1.1 christos /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2190 1.1 christos bfd *old_bfd;
2191 1.1 christos
2192 1.1 christos /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2193 1.1 christos union {
2194 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2195 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2196 1.1 christos } tlsld_got;
2197 1.1 christos
2198 1.1 christos /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2199 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2200 1.1 christos
2201 1.1 christos /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2202 1.1 christos unsigned int got_header_size;
2203 1.7 christos /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2204 1.7 christos unsigned int got_gap;
2205 1.7 christos
2206 1.7 christos /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2207 1.7 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2208 1.7 christos
2209 1.7 christos /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2210 1.7 christos referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2211 1.7 christos unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2212 1.7 christos unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2213 1.7 christos
2214 1.1 christos /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2215 1.1 christos unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2216 1.1 christos
2217 1.1 christos /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2218 1.1 christos unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2219 1.1 christos
2220 1.1 christos /* The size of PLT entries. */
2221 1.1 christos int plt_entry_size;
2222 1.1 christos /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2223 1.1 christos int plt_slot_size;
2224 1.1 christos /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2225 1.1 christos int plt_initial_entry_size;
2226 1.1 christos };
2227 1.1 christos
2228 1.9 christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2229 1.9 christos are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2230 1.9 christos
2231 1.1 christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2232 1.7 christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2233 1.7 christos
2234 1.7 christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2235 1.1 christos relocs. */
2236 1.1 christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2237 1.1 christos
2238 1.10 christos /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2239 1.10 christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2240 1.10 christos
2241 1.1 christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2242 1.1 christos
2243 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2244 1.1 christos ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
2245 1.1 christos && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) \
2246 1.1 christos ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
2247 1.1 christos
2248 1.1 christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2249 1.1 christos
2250 1.1 christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2251 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2252 1.1 christos struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2253 1.1 christos const char *string)
2254 1.1 christos {
2255 1.1 christos /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2256 1.1 christos subclass. */
2257 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2258 1.1 christos {
2259 1.1 christos entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2260 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2261 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2262 1.1 christos return entry;
2263 1.1 christos }
2264 1.1 christos
2265 1.1 christos /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2266 1.1 christos entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2267 1.1 christos if (entry != NULL)
2268 1.1 christos {
2269 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2270 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2271 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2272 1.1 christos }
2273 1.1 christos
2274 1.1 christos return entry;
2275 1.1 christos }
2276 1.1 christos
2277 1.7 christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2278 1.7 christos
2279 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2280 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2281 1.1 christos {
2282 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2283 1.1 christos static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2284 1.1 christos = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2285 1.1 christos
2286 1.1 christos ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2287 1.1 christos if (ret == NULL)
2288 1.1 christos return NULL;
2289 1.1 christos
2290 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2291 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2292 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2293 1.1 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2294 1.1 christos {
2295 1.1 christos free (ret);
2296 1.1 christos return NULL;
2297 1.1 christos }
2298 1.3 christos
2299 1.3 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2300 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2301 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2302 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2303 1.1 christos
2304 1.1 christos ret->params = &default_params;
2305 1.1 christos
2306 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2307 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2308 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2309 1.1 christos
2310 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2311 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2312 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2313 1.1 christos
2314 1.1 christos ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2315 1.3 christos ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2316 1.3 christos ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2317 1.3 christos
2318 1.3 christos return &ret->elf.root;
2319 1.3 christos }
2320 1.3 christos
2321 1.3 christos /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2322 1.3 christos
2323 1.3 christos void
2324 1.7 christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2325 1.3 christos {
2326 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2327 1.1 christos
2328 1.1 christos if (htab)
2329 1.10 christos htab->params = params;
2330 1.1 christos params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2331 1.1 christos }
2332 1.1 christos
2333 1.1 christos /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2334 1.1 christos
2335 1.10 christos static bool
2336 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2337 1.1 christos {
2338 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2339 1.1 christos
2340 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2341 1.1 christos return false;
2342 1.7 christos
2343 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2344 1.9 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2345 1.10 christos {
2346 1.1 christos /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2347 1.1 christos executable. */
2348 1.10 christos flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2349 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2350 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2351 1.3 christos return false;
2352 1.3 christos }
2353 1.3 christos
2354 1.3 christos return true;
2355 1.10 christos }
2356 1.3 christos
2357 1.3 christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2358 1.3 christos R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2359 1.3 christos and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2360 1.3 christos
2361 1.3 christos static bool
2362 1.3 christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2363 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2364 1.3 christos flagword flags,
2365 1.3 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2366 1.3 christos {
2367 1.3 christos asection *s;
2368 1.10 christos
2369 1.3 christos flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2370 1.3 christos | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2371 1.3 christos
2372 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2373 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
2374 1.3 christos return false;
2375 1.3 christos lsect->section = s;
2376 1.10 christos
2377 1.3 christos /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2378 1.10 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2379 1.3 christos
2380 1.3 christos lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2381 1.10 christos if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2382 1.1 christos return false;
2383 1.1 christos lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2384 1.1 christos return true;
2385 1.1 christos }
2386 1.1 christos
2387 1.7 christos static bool
2388 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2389 1.1 christos {
2390 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2391 1.1 christos asection *s;
2392 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2393 1.7 christos int p2align;
2394 1.7 christos
2395 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2396 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2397 1.9 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2398 1.10 christos htab->glink = s;
2399 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2400 1.1 christos if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2401 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2402 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2403 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2404 1.1 christos return false;
2405 1.1 christos
2406 1.1 christos if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2407 1.9 christos {
2408 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2409 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2410 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2411 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2412 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2413 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2414 1.1 christos return false;
2415 1.9 christos }
2416 1.10 christos
2417 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2418 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2419 1.1 christos htab->elf.iplt = s;
2420 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2421 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2422 1.1 christos return false;
2423 1.9 christos
2424 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2425 1.3 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2426 1.7 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2427 1.7 christos htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2428 1.7 christos if (s == NULL
2429 1.7 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2430 1.7 christos return false;
2431 1.7 christos
2432 1.9 christos /* Local plt entries. */
2433 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2434 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2435 1.7 christos htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2436 1.7 christos flags);
2437 1.7 christos if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2438 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2439 1.7 christos return false;
2440 1.7 christos
2441 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2442 1.9 christos {
2443 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2444 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2445 1.7 christos htab->relpltlocal
2446 1.3 christos = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2447 1.3 christos if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2448 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2449 1.3 christos return false;
2450 1.3 christos }
2451 1.3 christos
2452 1.10 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2453 1.3 christos &htab->sdata[0]))
2454 1.10 christos return false;
2455 1.1 christos
2456 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2457 1.1 christos &htab->sdata[1]))
2458 1.1 christos return false;
2459 1.1 christos
2460 1.1 christos return true;
2461 1.10 christos }
2462 1.1 christos
2463 1.1 christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2464 1.1 christos to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2465 1.1 christos to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2466 1.1 christos
2467 1.1 christos static bool
2468 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2469 1.1 christos {
2470 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2471 1.1 christos asection *s;
2472 1.10 christos flagword flags;
2473 1.1 christos
2474 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2475 1.10 christos
2476 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2477 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2478 1.1 christos return false;
2479 1.10 christos
2480 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2481 1.1 christos return false;
2482 1.1 christos
2483 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL
2484 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2485 1.10 christos return false;
2486 1.1 christos
2487 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2488 1.1 christos SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2489 1.1 christos htab->dynsbss = s;
2490 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
2491 1.1 christos return false;
2492 1.1 christos
2493 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2494 1.9 christos {
2495 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2496 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2497 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2498 1.10 christos htab->relsbss = s;
2499 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2500 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2501 1.1 christos return false;
2502 1.7 christos }
2503 1.1 christos
2504 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2505 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2506 1.1 christos return false;
2507 1.9 christos
2508 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
2509 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2510 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2511 1.1 christos /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2512 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2513 1.1 christos return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2514 1.1 christos }
2515 1.1 christos
2516 1.1 christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2517 1.1 christos
2518 1.1 christos static void
2519 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2520 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2521 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2522 1.1 christos {
2523 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2524 1.1 christos
2525 1.7 christos edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2526 1.7 christos eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2527 1.1 christos
2528 1.1 christos edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2529 1.7 christos edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2530 1.1 christos
2531 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2532 1.1 christos edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2533 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2534 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2535 1.7 christos edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2536 1.7 christos edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2537 1.10 christos edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2538 1.1 christos
2539 1.10 christos /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2540 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2541 1.1 christos return;
2542 1.1 christos
2543 1.1 christos if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2544 1.1 christos {
2545 1.1 christos if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2546 1.10 christos {
2547 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2548 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2549 1.1 christos
2550 1.10 christos /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2551 1.1 christos list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2552 1.1 christos for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2553 1.1 christos {
2554 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2555 1.1 christos
2556 1.1 christos for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2557 1.1 christos if (q->sec == p->sec)
2558 1.1 christos {
2559 1.1 christos q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2560 1.1 christos q->count += p->count;
2561 1.10 christos *pp = p->next;
2562 1.1 christos break;
2563 1.1 christos }
2564 1.10 christos if (q == NULL)
2565 1.10 christos pp = &p->next;
2566 1.1 christos }
2567 1.1 christos *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2568 1.1 christos }
2569 1.1 christos
2570 1.1 christos dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2571 1.1 christos ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2572 1.1 christos }
2573 1.1 christos
2574 1.1 christos /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2575 1.1 christos the symbol which just became indirect. */
2576 1.1 christos edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2577 1.1 christos eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2578 1.1 christos
2579 1.1 christos /* And plt entries. */
2580 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2581 1.1 christos {
2582 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2583 1.1 christos {
2584 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **entp;
2585 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2586 1.1 christos
2587 1.1 christos for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2588 1.1 christos {
2589 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *dent;
2590 1.1 christos
2591 1.1 christos for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2592 1.1 christos if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2593 1.1 christos {
2594 1.1 christos dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2595 1.1 christos *entp = ent->next;
2596 1.1 christos break;
2597 1.1 christos }
2598 1.1 christos if (dent == NULL)
2599 1.1 christos entp = &ent->next;
2600 1.1 christos }
2601 1.1 christos *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2602 1.1 christos }
2603 1.1 christos
2604 1.1 christos edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2605 1.1 christos eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2606 1.1 christos }
2607 1.1 christos
2608 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2609 1.1 christos {
2610 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2611 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2612 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2613 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2614 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2615 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2616 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2617 1.10 christos }
2618 1.1 christos }
2619 1.1 christos
2620 1.1 christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2621 1.1 christos file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2622 1.1 christos
2623 1.1 christos static bool
2624 1.1 christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2625 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2626 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2627 1.3 christos const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2628 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2629 1.1 christos asection **secp,
2630 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
2631 1.1 christos {
2632 1.1 christos if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2633 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2634 1.1 christos && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2635 1.1 christos && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2636 1.1 christos {
2637 1.1 christos /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2638 1.10 christos put into .sbss. */
2639 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2640 1.1 christos
2641 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2642 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2643 1.1 christos {
2644 1.1 christos flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2645 1.1 christos
2646 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2647 1.10 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2648 1.1 christos
2649 1.1 christos htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2650 1.1 christos ".sbss",
2651 1.1 christos flags);
2652 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2653 1.1 christos return false;
2654 1.10 christos }
2655 1.1 christos
2656 1.1 christos *secp = htab->sbss;
2657 1.1 christos *valp = sym->st_size;
2658 1.1 christos }
2659 1.1 christos
2660 1.1 christos return true;
2661 1.1 christos }
2662 1.1 christos
2663 1.1 christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2665 1.1 christos
2666 1.1 christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2667 1.1 christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2668 1.1 christos (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2669 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend,
2670 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2671 1.1 christos {
2672 1.1 christos for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2673 1.1 christos if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2674 1.10 christos return linker_pointers;
2675 1.3 christos
2676 1.3 christos return NULL;
2677 1.3 christos }
2678 1.3 christos
2679 1.1 christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2680 1.1 christos
2681 1.1 christos static bool
2682 1.1 christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2683 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2684 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2685 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2686 1.1 christos {
2687 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2688 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2689 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2690 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2691 1.1 christos
2692 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2693 1.1 christos
2694 1.1 christos /* Is this a global symbol? */
2695 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
2696 1.1 christos {
2697 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2698 1.1 christos
2699 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2700 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2701 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2702 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2703 1.1 christos lsect))
2704 1.1 christos return true;
2705 1.1 christos
2706 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2707 1.1 christos }
2708 1.1 christos else
2709 1.1 christos {
2710 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2711 1.1 christos
2712 1.1 christos /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2713 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2714 1.1 christos
2715 1.1 christos /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2716 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2717 1.1 christos {
2718 1.10 christos unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2719 1.1 christos
2720 1.1 christos amt = num_symbols;
2721 1.1 christos amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2722 1.1 christos ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2723 1.1 christos
2724 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2725 1.1 christos return false;
2726 1.1 christos
2727 1.10 christos elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2728 1.1 christos }
2729 1.1 christos
2730 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2731 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2732 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2733 1.1 christos lsect))
2734 1.1 christos return true;
2735 1.1 christos
2736 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2737 1.1 christos }
2738 1.1 christos
2739 1.10 christos /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2740 1.1 christos a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2741 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2742 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2743 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2744 1.1 christos
2745 1.1 christos if (!linker_section_ptr)
2746 1.9 christos return false;
2747 1.10 christos
2748 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2749 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2750 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2751 1.1 christos *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2752 1.1 christos
2753 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2754 1.1 christos return false;
2755 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2756 1.1 christos lsect->section->size += 4;
2757 1.1 christos
2758 1.10 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2759 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
2760 1.1 christos "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2761 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2762 1.1 christos (long) lsect->section->size);
2763 1.1 christos #endif
2764 1.1 christos
2765 1.1 christos return true;
2766 1.1 christos }
2767 1.1 christos
2768 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry **
2769 1.7 christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2770 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2771 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
2772 1.1 christos int tls_type)
2773 1.1 christos {
2774 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2775 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2776 1.1 christos unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2777 1.1 christos
2778 1.1 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2779 1.1 christos {
2780 1.1 christos bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2781 1.1 christos
2782 1.1 christos size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2783 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_plt)
2784 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2785 1.7 christos local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2786 1.7 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2787 1.7 christos return NULL;
2788 1.1 christos elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2789 1.1 christos }
2790 1.1 christos
2791 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2792 1.10 christos local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2793 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2794 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2795 1.1 christos local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2796 1.1 christos return local_plt + r_symndx;
2797 1.1 christos }
2798 1.1 christos
2799 1.1 christos static bool
2800 1.1 christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2801 1.1 christos asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2802 1.1 christos {
2803 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2804 1.1 christos
2805 1.10 christos if (addend < 32768)
2806 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2807 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2808 1.10 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2809 1.1 christos break;
2810 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2811 1.1 christos {
2812 1.1 christos size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2813 1.1 christos ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2814 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2815 1.1 christos return false;
2816 1.10 christos ent->next = *plist;
2817 1.1 christos ent->sec = sec;
2818 1.1 christos ent->addend = addend;
2819 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2820 1.1 christos *plist = ent;
2821 1.1 christos }
2822 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2823 1.1 christos return true;
2824 1.1 christos }
2825 1.1 christos
2826 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry *
2827 1.1 christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2828 1.1 christos {
2829 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2830 1.1 christos
2831 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768)
2832 1.10 christos sec = NULL;
2833 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2834 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2835 1.1 christos break;
2836 1.1 christos return ent;
2837 1.1 christos }
2838 1.1 christos
2839 1.1 christos static bool
2840 1.1 christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2841 1.1 christos {
2842 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2843 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2844 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2845 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2846 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2847 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2848 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2849 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2850 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2851 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2852 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2853 1.7 christos }
2854 1.7 christos
2855 1.7 christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2856 1.7 christos
2857 1.1 christos static bool
2858 1.1 christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2859 1.10 christos {
2860 1.10 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2861 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2862 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2863 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2864 1.10 christos }
2865 1.10 christos
2866 1.10 christos /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto. Return true
2867 1.10 christos iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits. */
2868 1.1 christos
2869 1.1 christos static bool
2870 1.1 christos offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
2871 1.7 christos {
2872 1.7 christos return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
2873 1.7 christos }
2874 1.1 christos
2875 1.1 christos static void
2876 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2877 1.1 christos {
2878 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
2879 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2880 1.1 christos (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2881 1.1 christos abfd,
2882 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2883 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2884 1.1 christos }
2885 1.1 christos
2886 1.1 christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2887 1.1 christos allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2888 1.1 christos table. */
2889 1.1 christos
2890 1.1 christos static bool
2891 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2892 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2893 1.1 christos asection *sec,
2894 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2895 1.1 christos {
2896 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2897 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2898 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2899 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2900 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2901 1.7 christos asection *got2, *sreloc;
2902 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2903 1.1 christos
2904 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2905 1.1 christos return true;
2906 1.1 christos
2907 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2908 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2909 1.1 christos sec, abfd);
2910 1.1 christos #endif
2911 1.1 christos
2912 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2913 1.1 christos
2914 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2915 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2916 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2917 1.10 christos
2918 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2919 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL)
2920 1.10 christos {
2921 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2922 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2923 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2924 1.1 christos return false;
2925 1.1 christos }
2926 1.1 christos tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2927 1.1 christos false, false, true);
2928 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2929 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2930 1.1 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2931 1.1 christos sreloc = NULL;
2932 1.10 christos
2933 1.1 christos rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2934 1.3 christos for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2935 1.7 christos {
2936 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
2937 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2938 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2939 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
2940 1.10 christos int tls_type;
2941 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2942 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **pltent;
2943 1.10 christos bfd_vma addend;
2944 1.10 christos
2945 1.10 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2946 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2947 1.1 christos {
2948 1.1 christos h = NULL;
2949 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
2950 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
2951 1.1 christos return false;
2952 1.10 christos }
2953 1.1 christos else
2954 1.1 christos {
2955 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2956 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2957 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2958 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2959 1.7 christos isym = NULL;
2960 1.1 christos }
2961 1.1 christos
2962 1.1 christos /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2963 1.1 christos This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2964 1.1 christos startup code. */
2965 1.10 christos if (h != NULL
2966 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2967 1.1 christos && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2968 1.1 christos {
2969 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2970 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2971 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2972 1.10 christos return false;
2973 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2974 1.10 christos }
2975 1.10 christos
2976 1.10 christos tls_type = 0;
2977 1.10 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2978 1.10 christos ifunc = NULL;
2979 1.10 christos if (h != NULL)
2980 1.10 christos {
2981 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2982 1.3 christos {
2983 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
2984 1.3 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
2985 1.1 christos }
2986 1.7 christos }
2987 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2988 1.10 christos {
2989 1.1 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2990 1.1 christos {
2991 1.1 christos /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2992 1.1 christos ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2993 1.3 christos NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2994 1.7 christos if (ifunc == NULL)
2995 1.7 christos return false;
2996 1.7 christos
2997 1.7 christos /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2998 1.1 christos In a non-pie executable even when there are
2999 1.7 christos no plt calls. */
3000 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
3001 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3002 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3003 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3004 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
3005 1.7 christos {
3006 1.7 christos addend = 0;
3007 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3008 1.3 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3009 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3010 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3011 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3012 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3013 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3014 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3015 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
3016 1.1 christos return false;
3017 1.1 christos }
3018 1.1 christos }
3019 1.1 christos }
3020 1.1 christos
3021 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
3022 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3023 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3024 1.1 christos && h == tga)
3025 1.1 christos {
3026 1.1 christos if (rel != relocs
3027 1.9 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3028 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3029 1.1 christos /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3030 1.10 christos reloc. */
3031 1.1 christos ;
3032 1.1 christos else
3033 1.1 christos /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3034 1.1 christos sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3035 1.1 christos }
3036 1.7 christos
3037 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
3038 1.7 christos {
3039 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3040 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3041 1.10 christos /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3042 1.7 christos its parameter symbol. */
3043 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
3044 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3045 1.1 christos else
3046 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3047 1.1 christos NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3048 1.1 christos return false;
3049 1.1 christos break;
3050 1.1 christos
3051 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3052 1.1 christos break;
3053 1.1 christos
3054 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3055 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3056 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3057 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3058 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3059 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3060 1.1 christos
3061 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3062 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3065 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3066 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3067 1.1 christos
3068 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3069 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3070 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3071 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3072 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3073 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3074 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3075 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3076 1.1 christos
3077 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3078 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3079 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3080 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3081 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3082 1.1 christos dogottls:
3083 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3084 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3085 1.7 christos
3086 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations */
3087 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
3088 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3089 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3090 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3091 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3092 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3093 1.1 christos {
3094 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3095 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3096 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3097 1.1 christos return false;
3098 1.1 christos }
3099 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3100 1.10 christos {
3101 1.1 christos h->got.refcount += 1;
3102 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3103 1.1 christos }
3104 1.3 christos else
3105 1.1 christos /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3106 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3107 1.10 christos return false;
3108 1.1 christos
3109 1.1 christos /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3110 1.1 christos an ifunc. */
3111 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3112 1.1 christos {
3113 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3114 1.3 christos return false;
3115 1.3 christos }
3116 1.10 christos break;
3117 1.1 christos
3118 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3119 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3120 1.10 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3121 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3122 1.1 christos h, rel))
3123 1.1 christos return false;
3124 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3125 1.1 christos {
3126 1.9 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3127 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3128 1.1 christos }
3129 1.10 christos break;
3130 1.1 christos
3131 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3132 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3133 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3134 1.10 christos {
3135 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3136 1.1 christos return false;
3137 1.10 christos }
3138 1.10 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3139 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3140 1.1 christos h, rel))
3141 1.1 christos return false;
3142 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3143 1.3 christos {
3144 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3145 1.3 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3146 1.1 christos }
3147 1.1 christos break;
3148 1.1 christos
3149 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3150 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3151 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3152 1.1 christos
3153 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3154 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3155 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3156 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3157 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3158 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3159 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3160 1.1 christos {
3161 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3162 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3163 1.1 christos }
3164 1.1 christos break;
3165 1.1 christos
3166 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3167 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3168 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3169 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3170 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3171 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3172 1.9 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3173 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3174 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3175 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3176 1.1 christos break;
3177 1.3 christos
3178 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3179 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3180 1.10 christos {
3181 1.10 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3182 1.1 christos return false;
3183 1.1 christos }
3184 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3185 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3186 1.1 christos {
3187 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3188 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3189 1.1 christos }
3190 1.1 christos break;
3191 1.10 christos
3192 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3193 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3194 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3195 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3196 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3197 1.1 christos {
3198 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3199 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3200 1.1 christos }
3201 1.1 christos break;
3202 1.10 christos
3203 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3204 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3205 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3206 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3207 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3208 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
3209 1.7 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3210 1.7 christos break;
3211 1.7 christos
3212 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3213 1.7 christos if (h == NULL)
3214 1.7 christos break;
3215 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3216 1.1 christos goto pltentry;
3217 1.1 christos
3218 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3219 1.1 christos sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3220 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
3221 1.1 christos
3222 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
3223 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3224 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3225 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3226 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3227 1.7 christos pltentry:
3228 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3229 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3230 1.10 christos #endif
3231 1.7 christos /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3232 1.7 christos if (h == NULL)
3233 1.1 christos {
3234 1.7 christos pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3235 1.7 christos NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3236 1.1 christos if (pltent == NULL)
3237 1.7 christos return false;
3238 1.1 christos }
3239 1.7 christos else
3240 1.7 christos {
3241 1.7 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3242 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3243 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3244 1.7 christos pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3245 1.7 christos }
3246 1.7 christos addend = 0;
3247 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3248 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3249 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3250 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3251 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3252 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3253 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3254 1.1 christos return false;
3255 1.1 christos break;
3256 1.1 christos
3257 1.1 christos /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3258 1.1 christos relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3259 1.1 christos section relative. */
3260 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3261 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3262 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3263 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3264 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3265 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3266 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3267 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3268 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16:
3269 1.1 christos break;
3270 1.1 christos
3271 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
3272 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3273 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3274 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3275 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3276 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3277 1.1 christos break;
3278 1.1 christos
3279 1.1 christos /* These are just markers. */
3280 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
3281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3282 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
3283 1.1 christos case R_PPC_max:
3284 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
3285 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3286 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3287 1.1 christos case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3288 1.1 christos break;
3289 1.1 christos
3290 1.1 christos /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3291 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
3292 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3293 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3294 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3295 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3296 1.1 christos break;
3297 1.1 christos
3298 1.1 christos /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3299 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3300 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3301 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3302 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3303 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3304 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3305 1.1 christos break;
3306 1.1 christos
3307 1.10 christos /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3308 1.10 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3309 1.10 christos if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3310 1.10 christos {
3311 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3312 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3313 1.1 christos }
3314 1.1 christos if (h != NULL
3315 1.1 christos && ifunc != NULL
3316 1.1 christos && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
3317 1.10 christos return false;
3318 1.1 christos break;
3319 1.1 christos
3320 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3321 1.1 christos Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3322 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3323 1.9 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3324 1.10 christos return false;
3325 1.1 christos break;
3326 1.1 christos
3327 1.10 christos /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3328 1.10 christos used. Record for later use during GC. */
3329 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3330 1.10 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3331 1.7 christos return false;
3332 1.1 christos break;
3333 1.1 christos
3334 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3335 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3336 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3337 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3338 1.1 christos /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3339 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3340 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3341 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3342 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3343 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3344 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3345 1.1 christos
3346 1.1 christos /* Nor these. */
3347 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3348 1.3 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3349 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3350 1.1 christos
3351 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
3352 1.1 christos if (h == NULL
3353 1.1 christos && got2 != NULL
3354 1.1 christos && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3355 1.1 christos && bfd_link_pic (info)
3356 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3357 1.1 christos {
3358 1.1 christos /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3359 1.1 christos the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3360 1.1 christos reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3361 1.1 christos force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3362 1.1 christos reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3363 1.1 christos PLT call stubs. */
3364 1.1 christos asection *s;
3365 1.1 christos
3366 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3367 1.1 christos if (s == got2)
3368 1.1 christos {
3369 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3370 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3371 1.1 christos }
3372 1.1 christos }
3373 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3374 1.1 christos break;
3375 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3376 1.1 christos
3377 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3378 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3379 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3380 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3381 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3382 1.10 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3383 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3384 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3385 1.1 christos {
3386 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3387 1.3 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3388 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3389 1.3 christos return false;
3390 1.3 christos
3391 1.1 christos /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3392 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = 1;
3393 1.1 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3394 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3395 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3396 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3397 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3398 1.1 christos }
3399 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3400 1.1 christos
3401 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
3402 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
3403 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3404 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3405 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3406 1.1 christos break;
3407 1.1 christos if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3408 1.1 christos {
3409 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3410 1.1 christos {
3411 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3412 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3413 1.1 christos }
3414 1.1 christos break;
3415 1.3 christos }
3416 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3417 1.1 christos
3418 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3419 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3420 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3421 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3422 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3423 1.1 christos {
3424 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3425 1.1 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3426 1.10 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3427 1.10 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3428 1.10 christos return false;
3429 1.10 christos break;
3430 1.10 christos }
3431 1.10 christos
3432 1.10 christos dodyn:
3433 1.10 christos /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
3434 1.10 christos relocations. At this point in linking we have read all
3435 1.10 christos the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
3436 1.10 christos yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
3437 1.10 christos symbol flags. In some cases we might be setting dynamic
3438 1.10 christos reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
3439 1.10 christos That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
3440 1.10 christos work together with this code. */
3441 1.1 christos if ((h != NULL
3442 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
3443 1.1 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
3444 1.1 christos && (h != NULL
3445 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
3446 1.1 christos : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
3447 1.1 christos && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
3448 1.1 christos {
3449 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3450 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
3451 1.1 christos "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3452 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
3453 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
3454 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3455 1.10 christos #endif
3456 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3457 1.1 christos {
3458 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3459 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3460 1.1 christos
3461 1.1 christos sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3462 1.1 christos (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
3463 1.1 christos
3464 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3465 1.3 christos return false;
3466 1.3 christos }
3467 1.3 christos
3468 1.10 christos /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3469 1.3 christos relocations we need for this symbol. */
3470 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3471 1.3 christos {
3472 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3473 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3474 1.10 christos
3475 1.3 christos rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3476 1.3 christos p = *rel_head;
3477 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3478 1.3 christos {
3479 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3480 1.3 christos if (p == NULL)
3481 1.3 christos return false;
3482 1.3 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3483 1.3 christos *rel_head = p;
3484 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3485 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3486 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
3487 1.1 christos }
3488 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3489 1.1 christos if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3490 1.3 christos p->pc_count += 1;
3491 1.3 christos }
3492 1.10 christos else
3493 1.1 christos {
3494 1.1 christos /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3495 1.1 christos We really need local syms available to do this
3496 1.1 christos easily. Oh well. */
3497 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3498 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3499 1.1 christos bool is_ifunc;
3500 1.1 christos asection *s;
3501 1.3 christos void *vpp;
3502 1.10 christos
3503 1.3 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3504 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
3505 1.3 christos s = sec;
3506 1.3 christos
3507 1.3 christos vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3508 1.3 christos rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3509 1.3 christos is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
3510 1.10 christos p = *rel_head;
3511 1.3 christos if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3512 1.3 christos p = p->next;
3513 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3514 1.3 christos {
3515 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3516 1.3 christos if (p == NULL)
3517 1.3 christos return false;
3518 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3519 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3520 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3521 1.1 christos p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3522 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3523 1.1 christos }
3524 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3525 1.10 christos }
3526 1.1 christos }
3527 1.1 christos
3528 1.7 christos break;
3529 1.7 christos }
3530 1.10 christos }
3531 1.7 christos
3532 1.1 christos return true;
3533 1.7 christos }
3534 1.1 christos
3535 1.1 christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3537 1.10 christos and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3538 1.10 christos bool
3539 1.10 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3540 1.10 christos {
3541 1.10 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3542 1.10 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3543 1.10 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3544 1.10 christos bool ret = true;
3545 1.10 christos bool warn_only;
3546 1.10 christos
3547 1.10 christos /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3548 1.1 christos libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3549 1.1 christos but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc
3550 1.1 christos typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3551 1.1 christos but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3552 1.1 christos The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3553 1.1 christos object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3554 1.7 christos layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */
3555 1.1 christos warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3556 1.1 christos
3557 1.7 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3558 1.7 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3559 1.7 christos
3560 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3561 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3562 1.7 christos
3563 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3564 1.7 christos {
3565 1.10 christos int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3566 1.10 christos int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3567 1.10 christos static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3568 1.10 christos
3569 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3570 1.10 christos ;
3571 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3572 1.7 christos {
3573 1.7 christos if (!warn_only)
3574 1.7 christos {
3575 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3576 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3577 1.7 christos last_fp = ibfd;
3578 1.10 christos }
3579 1.7 christos }
3580 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3581 1.7 christos {
3582 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3583 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3584 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3585 1.7 christos last_fp, ibfd);
3586 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3587 1.7 christos }
3588 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3589 1.7 christos {
3590 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3591 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3592 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3593 1.7 christos ibfd, last_fp);
3594 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3595 1.7 christos }
3596 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3597 1.7 christos {
3598 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3599 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3600 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3601 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3602 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3603 1.7 christos }
3604 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3605 1.7 christos {
3606 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3607 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3608 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3609 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3610 1.7 christos ret = warn_only;
3611 1.10 christos }
3612 1.10 christos
3613 1.10 christos in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3614 1.10 christos out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3615 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3616 1.10 christos ;
3617 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3618 1.7 christos {
3619 1.7 christos if (!warn_only)
3620 1.7 christos {
3621 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3622 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3623 1.7 christos last_ld = ibfd;
3624 1.10 christos }
3625 1.7 christos }
3626 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3627 1.7 christos {
3628 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3629 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3630 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3631 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3632 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3633 1.7 christos }
3634 1.7 christos else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3635 1.7 christos {
3636 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3637 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3638 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3639 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3640 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3641 1.7 christos }
3642 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3643 1.7 christos {
3644 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3645 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3646 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3647 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3648 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3649 1.7 christos }
3650 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3651 1.7 christos {
3652 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3653 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3654 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3655 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3656 1.1 christos ret = warn_only;
3657 1.7 christos }
3658 1.7 christos }
3659 1.7 christos
3660 1.7 christos if (!ret)
3661 1.7 christos {
3662 1.10 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3663 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3664 1.7 christos }
3665 1.7 christos return ret;
3666 1.7 christos }
3667 1.7 christos
3668 1.10 christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3669 1.7 christos there are conflicting attributes. */
3670 1.7 christos static bool
3671 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3672 1.7 christos {
3673 1.7 christos bfd *obfd;
3674 1.7 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3675 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3676 1.1 christos bool ret;
3677 1.1 christos
3678 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3679 1.1 christos return false;
3680 1.1 christos
3681 1.10 christos obfd = info->output_bfd;
3682 1.1 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3683 1.1 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3684 1.7 christos
3685 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3686 1.7 christos merge non-conflicting ones. */
3687 1.1 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3688 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3689 1.7 christos ret = true;
3690 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3691 1.1 christos {
3692 1.7 christos int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3693 1.7 christos int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3694 1.7 christos static bfd *last_vec;
3695 1.1 christos
3696 1.1 christos if (in_vec == 0)
3697 1.1 christos ;
3698 1.1 christos else if (out_vec == 0)
3699 1.1 christos {
3700 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3701 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3702 1.1 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3703 1.7 christos }
3704 1.7 christos /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3705 1.7 christos without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3706 1.7 christos alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3707 1.7 christos not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3708 1.7 christos case too. */
3709 1.7 christos else if (in_vec == 1)
3710 1.7 christos ;
3711 1.7 christos else if (out_vec == 1)
3712 1.7 christos {
3713 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3714 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3715 1.7 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3716 1.10 christos }
3717 1.7 christos else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3718 1.7 christos {
3719 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3720 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3721 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3722 1.7 christos last_vec, ibfd);
3723 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3724 1.7 christos ret = false;
3725 1.10 christos }
3726 1.7 christos else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3727 1.1 christos {
3728 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3729 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3730 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3731 1.1 christos ibfd, last_vec);
3732 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3733 1.1 christos ret = false;
3734 1.1 christos }
3735 1.7 christos }
3736 1.7 christos
3737 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3738 1.7 christos and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3739 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3740 1.1 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3741 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3742 1.7 christos {
3743 1.7 christos int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3744 1.7 christos int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3745 1.7 christos static bfd *last_struct;
3746 1.7 christos
3747 1.7 christos if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3748 1.7 christos ;
3749 1.7 christos else if (out_struct == 0)
3750 1.7 christos {
3751 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3752 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_struct;
3753 1.7 christos last_struct = ibfd;
3754 1.10 christos }
3755 1.7 christos else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3756 1.7 christos {
3757 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3758 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3759 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3760 1.7 christos "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3761 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3762 1.7 christos ret = false;
3763 1.10 christos }
3764 1.7 christos else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3765 1.7 christos {
3766 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3767 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3768 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3769 1.10 christos "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3770 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3771 1.1 christos ret = false;
3772 1.1 christos }
3773 1.7 christos }
3774 1.1 christos if (!ret)
3775 1.1 christos {
3776 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3777 1.1 christos return false;
3778 1.1 christos }
3779 1.10 christos
3780 1.7 christos /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3781 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3782 1.7 christos }
3783 1.1 christos
3784 1.1 christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3785 1.10 christos object file when linking. */
3786 1.1 christos
3787 1.1 christos static bool
3788 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3789 1.1 christos {
3790 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3791 1.7 christos flagword old_flags;
3792 1.10 christos flagword new_flags;
3793 1.1 christos bool error;
3794 1.7 christos
3795 1.10 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3796 1.10 christos return true;
3797 1.10 christos
3798 1.10 christos /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3799 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3800 1.1 christos return false;
3801 1.1 christos
3802 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3803 1.1 christos return false;
3804 1.1 christos
3805 1.10 christos if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3806 1.1 christos return true;
3807 1.1 christos
3808 1.1 christos new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3809 1.1 christos old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3810 1.1 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3811 1.1 christos {
3812 1.1 christos /* First call, no flags set. */
3813 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
3814 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3815 1.1 christos }
3816 1.1 christos
3817 1.1 christos /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3818 1.10 christos else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3819 1.1 christos ;
3820 1.1 christos
3821 1.1 christos /* Incompatible flags. */
3822 1.10 christos else
3823 1.7 christos {
3824 1.7 christos /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3825 1.1 christos to be linked with either. */
3826 1.1 christos error = false;
3827 1.1 christos if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3828 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3829 1.1 christos {
3830 1.10 christos error = true;
3831 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3832 1.7 christos (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3833 1.1 christos "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3834 1.1 christos }
3835 1.1 christos else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3836 1.1 christos && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3837 1.1 christos {
3838 1.1 christos error = true;
3839 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3840 1.1 christos (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3841 1.1 christos "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3842 1.1 christos }
3843 1.1 christos
3844 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3845 1.1 christos if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3846 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3847 1.1 christos
3848 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3849 1.1 christos but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3850 1.1 christos if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3851 1.1 christos && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3852 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3853 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3854 1.1 christos
3855 1.1 christos /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3856 1.1 christos any module uses it. */
3857 1.10 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3858 1.7 christos
3859 1.7 christos new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3860 1.7 christos old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3861 1.7 christos
3862 1.7 christos /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3863 1.1 christos if (new_flags != old_flags)
3864 1.1 christos {
3865 1.1 christos error = true;
3866 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3867 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3868 1.10 christos (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3869 1.1 christos "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3870 1.1 christos ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3871 1.1 christos }
3872 1.10 christos
3873 1.1 christos if (error)
3874 1.1 christos {
3875 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3876 1.7 christos return false;
3877 1.7 christos }
3878 1.7 christos }
3879 1.7 christos
3880 1.3 christos return true;
3881 1.7 christos }
3882 1.10 christos
3883 1.7 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
3884 1.9 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3885 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
3886 1.10 christos unsigned long offset,
3887 1.10 christos bfd_byte *loc,
3888 1.7 christos bfd_vma value,
3889 1.9 christos split16_format_type split16_format,
3890 1.7 christos bool fixup)
3891 1.7 christos {
3892 1.7 christos unsigned int insn, opcode;
3893 1.7 christos
3894 1.7 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
3895 1.7 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3896 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3897 1.7 christos opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3898 1.7 christos if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3899 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3900 1.7 christos || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3901 1.7 christos || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3902 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3903 1.7 christos {
3904 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3905 1.7 christos {
3906 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3907 1.7 christos split16_format = split16a_type;
3908 1.7 christos else
3909 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3910 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3911 1.7 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3912 1.7 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3913 1.7 christos }
3914 1.7 christos }
3915 1.7 christos else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3916 1.7 christos || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3917 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3918 1.7 christos || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3919 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3920 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3921 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3922 1.7 christos {
3923 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3924 1.7 christos {
3925 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3926 1.9 christos split16_format = split16d_type;
3927 1.9 christos else
3928 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
3929 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3930 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3931 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3932 1.9 christos }
3933 1.9 christos }
3934 1.9 christos if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3935 1.9 christos {
3936 1.9 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3937 1.9 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3938 1.9 christos if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3939 1.9 christos {
3940 1.9 christos /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3941 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3942 1.7 christos insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3943 1.7 christos }
3944 1.10 christos }
3945 1.7 christos else
3946 1.1 christos {
3947 1.7 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3948 1.7 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3949 1.1 christos }
3950 1.7 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3951 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3952 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
3953 1.7 christos }
3954 1.7 christos
3955 1.7 christos static void
3956 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3957 1.7 christos {
3958 1.7 christos unsigned int insn;
3959 1.3 christos
3960 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3961 1.1 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3962 1.1 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3963 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3964 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3965 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3966 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3967 1.1 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3968 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3969 1.1 christos }
3970 1.1 christos
3971 1.1 christos
3972 1.1 christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3974 1.1 christos Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3975 1.1 christos int
3976 1.1 christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3977 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
3978 1.1 christos {
3979 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3980 1.1 christos flagword flags;
3981 1.3 christos
3982 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3983 1.1 christos
3984 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3985 1.1 christos {
3986 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3987 1.1 christos
3988 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3989 1.7 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3990 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3991 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3992 1.1 christos && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3993 1.1 christos false, false, true)) != NULL
3994 1.1 christos && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3995 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
3996 1.1 christos && h->ref_regular
3997 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3998 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3999 1.1 christos {
4000 1.3 christos /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
4001 1.1 christos secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
4002 1.1 christos function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
4003 1.1 christos r30 to be set up. */
4004 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4005 1.1 christos }
4006 1.1 christos else
4007 1.1 christos {
4008 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd;
4009 1.1 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4010 1.1 christos
4011 1.1 christos /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4012 1.1 christos Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4013 1.1 christos without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4014 1.1 christos --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4015 1.1 christos if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4016 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4017 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4018 1.1 christos if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4019 1.1 christos {
4020 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4021 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4022 1.1 christos else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4023 1.3 christos {
4024 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4025 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4026 1.7 christos break;
4027 1.1 christos }
4028 1.7 christos }
4029 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4030 1.1 christos }
4031 1.1 christos }
4032 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4033 1.1 christos {
4034 1.1 christos if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4035 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4036 1.1 christos else
4037 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4038 1.1 christos }
4039 1.7 christos
4040 1.9 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4041 1.1 christos
4042 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4043 1.1 christos {
4044 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4045 1.9 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4046 1.1 christos
4047 1.1 christos /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4048 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4049 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4050 1.1 christos return -1;
4051 1.1 christos
4052 1.9 christos /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4053 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4054 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4055 1.1 christos return -1;
4056 1.1 christos }
4057 1.1 christos else
4058 1.1 christos {
4059 1.1 christos /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4060 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
4061 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4062 1.1 christos return -1;
4063 1.1 christos }
4064 1.1 christos return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4065 1.1 christos }
4066 1.1 christos
4067 1.1 christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4069 1.1 christos relocation. */
4070 1.1 christos
4071 1.1 christos static asection *
4072 1.1 christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4073 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
4074 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4075 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4076 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4077 1.1 christos {
4078 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4079 1.10 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4080 1.7 christos {
4081 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4082 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4083 1.7 christos return NULL;
4084 1.7 christos }
4085 1.7 christos
4086 1.7 christos return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4087 1.1 christos }
4088 1.7 christos
4089 1.1 christos static bool
4090 1.7 christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4091 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4092 1.7 christos asection **symsecp,
4093 1.7 christos unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4094 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4095 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
4096 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd)
4097 1.7 christos {
4098 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4099 1.1 christos
4100 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4101 1.7 christos {
4102 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4103 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4104 1.7 christos
4105 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4106 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4107 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4108 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4109 1.7 christos
4110 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL)
4111 1.7 christos *hp = h;
4112 1.7 christos
4113 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4114 1.1 christos *symp = NULL;
4115 1.7 christos
4116 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4117 1.7 christos {
4118 1.7 christos asection *symsec = NULL;
4119 1.7 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4120 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4121 1.7 christos symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4122 1.1 christos *symsecp = symsec;
4123 1.7 christos }
4124 1.7 christos
4125 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4126 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4127 1.7 christos }
4128 1.7 christos else
4129 1.7 christos {
4130 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4131 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4132 1.7 christos
4133 1.1 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4134 1.7 christos {
4135 1.1 christos locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4136 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4137 1.7 christos locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4138 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4139 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4140 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4141 1.1 christos return false;
4142 1.7 christos *locsymsp = locsyms;
4143 1.7 christos }
4144 1.1 christos sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4145 1.7 christos
4146 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL)
4147 1.7 christos *hp = NULL;
4148 1.7 christos
4149 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4150 1.7 christos *symp = sym;
4151 1.7 christos
4152 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4153 1.1 christos *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4154 1.7 christos
4155 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4156 1.7 christos {
4157 1.7 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4158 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4159 1.1 christos
4160 1.7 christos tls_mask = NULL;
4161 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4162 1.1 christos if (local_got != NULL)
4163 1.10 christos {
4164 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4165 1.1 christos (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4166 1.7 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4167 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4168 1.1 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4169 1.10 christos }
4170 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4171 1.1 christos }
4172 1.1 christos }
4173 1.7 christos return true;
4174 1.7 christos }
4175 1.7 christos
4176 1.1 christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4178 1.7 christos defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4179 1.10 christos
4180 1.7 christos bool
4181 1.7 christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4182 1.7 christos {
4183 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4184 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd;
4185 1.7 christos asection *sec;
4186 1.7 christos bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4187 1.7 christos
4188 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4189 1.7 christos if (htab == NULL)
4190 1.7 christos return false;
4191 1.7 christos
4192 1.7 christos /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4193 1.7 christos reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4194 1.7 christos between the call and its destination. */
4195 1.3 christos limit = 0x1e00000;
4196 1.7 christos low_vma = -1;
4197 1.7 christos high_vma = 0;
4198 1.7 christos for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4199 1.7 christos if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4200 1.7 christos {
4201 1.7 christos if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4202 1.10 christos low_vma = sec->vma;
4203 1.7 christos if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4204 1.7 christos high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4205 1.7 christos }
4206 1.7 christos
4207 1.7 christos /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4208 1.7 christos convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4209 1.7 christos is local. */
4210 1.7 christos if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4211 1.7 christos {
4212 1.7 christos htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4213 1.7 christos return true;
4214 1.7 christos }
4215 1.7 christos
4216 1.7 christos /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4217 1.7 christos call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4218 1.7 christos the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4219 1.7 christos this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4220 1.7 christos will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4221 1.7 christos particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4222 1.7 christos difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4223 1.7 christos linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4224 1.7 christos particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4225 1.7 christos call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4226 1.7 christos the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4227 1.7 christos together except their symbol. */
4228 1.7 christos
4229 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4230 1.7 christos {
4231 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4232 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4233 1.7 christos
4234 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4235 1.7 christos continue;
4236 1.7 christos
4237 1.7 christos local_syms = NULL;
4238 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4239 1.10 christos
4240 1.7 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4241 1.7 christos if (sec->has_pltcall
4242 1.8 rin && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4243 1.7 christos {
4244 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4245 1.7 christos
4246 1.7 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4247 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4248 1.7 christos info->keep_memory);
4249 1.7 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4250 1.7 christos return false;
4251 1.7 christos
4252 1.7 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4253 1.7 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4254 1.7 christos {
4255 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4256 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4257 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec;
4258 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4259 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4260 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4261 1.10 christos
4262 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4263 1.10 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4264 1.7 christos continue;
4265 1.7 christos
4266 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4267 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4268 1.7 christos r_symndx, ibfd))
4269 1.7 christos {
4270 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4271 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4272 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4273 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
4274 1.7 christos return false;
4275 1.7 christos }
4276 1.7 christos
4277 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4278 1.7 christos {
4279 1.7 christos bfd_vma from, to;
4280 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
4281 1.7 christos to = h->root.u.def.value;
4282 1.7 christos else
4283 1.7 christos to = sym->st_value;
4284 1.7 christos to += (rel->r_addend
4285 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_offset
4286 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4287 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset
4288 1.7 christos + sec->output_offset
4289 1.7 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
4290 1.7 christos if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4291 1.7 christos *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4292 1.7 christos }
4293 1.7 christos }
4294 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4295 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4296 1.7 christos }
4297 1.10 christos
4298 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL
4299 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4300 1.7 christos {
4301 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
4302 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
4303 1.7 christos else
4304 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4305 1.7 christos }
4306 1.7 christos }
4307 1.7 christos
4308 1.7 christos return true;
4309 1.7 christos }
4310 1.10 christos
4311 1.7 christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4312 1.10 christos generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4313 1.7 christos
4314 1.7 christos asection *
4315 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4316 1.1 christos {
4317 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4318 1.10 christos
4319 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4320 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4321 1.1 christos false, false, true);
4322 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4323 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4324 1.1 christos
4325 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4326 1.1 christos {
4327 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4328 1.1 christos opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4329 1.1 christos false, false, true);
4330 1.1 christos if (opt != NULL
4331 1.1 christos && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4332 1.1 christos || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4333 1.7 christos {
4334 1.1 christos /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4335 1.1 christos signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4336 1.1 christos be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4337 1.1 christos make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4338 1.1 christos tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4339 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4340 1.1 christos && tga != NULL
4341 1.1 christos && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4342 1.1 christos || tga->needs_plt)
4343 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4344 1.7 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4345 1.1 christos {
4346 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4347 1.1 christos for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4348 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4349 1.1 christos break;
4350 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL)
4351 1.1 christos {
4352 1.10 christos tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4353 1.1 christos tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4354 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4355 1.1 christos opt->mark = 1;
4356 1.1 christos if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4357 1.1 christos {
4358 1.1 christos /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4359 1.10 christos opt->dynindx = -1;
4360 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4361 1.1 christos opt->dynstr_index);
4362 1.7 christos if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4363 1.7 christos return false;
4364 1.1 christos }
4365 1.7 christos htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4366 1.7 christos }
4367 1.1 christos }
4368 1.1 christos }
4369 1.1 christos else
4370 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4371 1.1 christos }
4372 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4373 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4374 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4375 1.10 christos {
4376 1.1 christos elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4377 1.1 christos elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4378 1.1 christos }
4379 1.1 christos
4380 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4381 1.1 christos }
4382 1.1 christos
4383 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4384 1.1 christos HASH. */
4385 1.1 christos
4386 1.1 christos static bool
4387 1.1 christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4388 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4389 1.1 christos const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4390 1.1 christos {
4391 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4392 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4393 1.1 christos unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4394 1.10 christos
4395 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4396 1.10 christos {
4397 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4398 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4399 1.1 christos
4400 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4401 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4402 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4403 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4404 1.1 christos if (h == hash)
4405 1.1 christos return true;
4406 1.1 christos }
4407 1.1 christos return false;
4408 1.1 christos }
4409 1.1 christos
4410 1.1 christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4411 1.3 christos opportunities. */
4412 1.10 christos
4413 1.1 christos bool
4414 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4415 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4416 1.10 christos {
4417 1.10 christos bfd *ibfd;
4418 1.10 christos asection *sec;
4419 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4420 1.1 christos int pass;
4421 1.1 christos
4422 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4423 1.1 christos return true;
4424 1.1 christos
4425 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4426 1.1 christos if (htab == NULL)
4427 1.3 christos return false;
4428 1.1 christos
4429 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4430 1.1 christos
4431 1.1 christos /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4432 1.1 christos relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4433 1.1 christos followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4434 1.1 christos optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4435 1.1 christos notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4436 1.1 christos adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4437 1.1 christos for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4438 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4439 1.1 christos {
4440 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4441 1.1 christos asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4442 1.10 christos
4443 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4444 1.1 christos if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4445 1.1 christos {
4446 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4447 1.1 christos int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4448 1.1 christos
4449 1.1 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4450 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4451 1.7 christos info->keep_memory);
4452 1.10 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4453 1.1 christos return false;
4454 1.1 christos
4455 1.1 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4456 1.1 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4457 1.1 christos {
4458 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4459 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4460 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4461 1.1 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4462 1.1 christos unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4463 1.1 christos bool is_local;
4464 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4465 1.1 christos
4466 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4467 1.9 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4468 1.1 christos {
4469 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4470 1.1 christos
4471 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4472 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4473 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4474 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4475 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4476 1.9 christos }
4477 1.1 christos
4478 1.1 christos is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4479 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4480 1.1 christos /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4481 1.1 christos without marker relocs, then check that each
4482 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4483 1.1 christos that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4484 1.1 christos setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4485 1.1 christos relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4486 1.1 christos if (pass == 0
4487 1.10 christos && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4488 1.1 christos && h != NULL
4489 1.1 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4490 1.1 christos && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4491 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4492 1.1 christos {
4493 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4494 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4495 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4496 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4497 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4498 1.1 christos return true;
4499 1.1 christos }
4500 1.1 christos
4501 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4502 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
4503 1.1 christos {
4504 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4505 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4506 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4507 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4508 1.1 christos
4509 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4510 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4511 1.1 christos /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4512 1.1 christos defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4513 1.1 christos that turns out to be the case. */
4514 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4515 1.1 christos continue;
4516 1.1 christos
4517 1.1 christos /* LD -> LE */
4518 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4519 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4520 1.1 christos break;
4521 1.1 christos
4522 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4523 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4524 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4525 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4526 1.1 christos
4527 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4528 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4529 1.1 christos if (is_local)
4530 1.1 christos /* GD -> LE */
4531 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4532 1.1 christos else
4533 1.1 christos /* GD -> IE */
4534 1.1 christos tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4535 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4536 1.1 christos break;
4537 1.1 christos
4538 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4539 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4540 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4541 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4542 1.9 christos if (is_local)
4543 1.9 christos {
4544 1.9 christos /* IE -> LE */
4545 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4546 1.7 christos tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4547 1.7 christos break;
4548 1.7 christos }
4549 1.7 christos else
4550 1.7 christos continue;
4551 1.7 christos
4552 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4553 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4554 1.7 christos continue;
4555 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
4556 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4557 1.7 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4558 1.7 christos && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4559 1.7 christos {
4560 1.7 christos if (pass != 0
4561 1.7 christos && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4562 1.7 christos {
4563 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4564 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4565 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4566 1.7 christos {
4567 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4568 1.7 christos
4569 1.7 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4570 1.7 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4571 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4572 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4573 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4574 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
4575 1.7 christos {
4576 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4577 1.7 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4578 1.7 christos
4579 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4580 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
4581 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4582 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4583 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL
4584 1.1 christos && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4585 1.10 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4586 1.10 christos }
4587 1.10 christos }
4588 1.10 christos }
4589 1.10 christos continue;
4590 1.10 christos }
4591 1.10 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4592 1.10 christos tls_set = 0;
4593 1.10 christos tls_clear = 0;
4594 1.10 christos break;
4595 1.10 christos
4596 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
4597 1.10 christos if (pass == 0)
4598 1.10 christos {
4599 1.10 christos unsigned char buf[4];
4600 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
4601 1.10 christos bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
4602 1.10 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
4603 1.10 christos off, 4))
4604 1.10 christos {
4605 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4606 1.10 christos free (relstart);
4607 1.10 christos return false;
4608 1.10 christos }
4609 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
4610 1.10 christos /* addis rt,2,imm */
4611 1.10 christos if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
4612 1.10 christos != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
4613 1.10 christos {
4614 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
4615 1.10 christos info->callbacks->minfo
4616 1.1 christos (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
4617 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
4618 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4619 1.1 christos }
4620 1.1 christos }
4621 1.1 christos continue;
4622 1.1 christos
4623 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
4624 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4625 1.1 christos continue;
4626 1.1 christos
4627 1.1 christos default:
4628 1.1 christos continue;
4629 1.1 christos }
4630 1.1 christos
4631 1.1 christos if (pass == 0)
4632 1.1 christos {
4633 1.1 christos if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4634 1.1 christos || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4635 1.1 christos continue;
4636 1.1 christos
4637 1.1 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4638 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4639 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
4640 1.10 christos continue;
4641 1.1 christos
4642 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4643 1.1 christos could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4644 1.1 christos from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4645 1.1 christos the entire optimization. */
4646 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4647 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4648 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4649 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4650 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4651 1.1 christos return true;
4652 1.7 christos }
4653 1.1 christos
4654 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4655 1.1 christos {
4656 1.1 christos tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4657 1.1 christos got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4658 1.1 christos }
4659 1.7 christos else
4660 1.7 christos {
4661 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4662 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4663 1.1 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4664 1.1 christos
4665 1.7 christos lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4666 1.7 christos if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4667 1.7 christos abort ();
4668 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4669 1.7 christos (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4670 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4671 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4672 1.7 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4673 1.9 christos got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4674 1.7 christos }
4675 1.7 christos
4676 1.7 christos /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4677 1.7 christos without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4678 1.9 christos found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4679 1.7 christos marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4680 1.7 christos broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4681 1.7 christos indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4682 1.7 christos Disable optimization in this case. */
4683 1.7 christos if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4684 1.7 christos && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4685 1.7 christos && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4686 1.7 christos != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4687 1.7 christos continue;
4688 1.7 christos
4689 1.7 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4690 1.7 christos {
4691 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4692 1.9 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4693 1.9 christos
4694 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4695 1.1 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4696 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4697 1.1 christos addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4698 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4699 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4700 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4701 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4702 1.1 christos }
4703 1.1 christos if (tls_clear == 0)
4704 1.1 christos continue;
4705 1.1 christos
4706 1.1 christos if (tls_set == 0)
4707 1.1 christos {
4708 1.1 christos /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4709 1.1 christos if (*got_count > 0)
4710 1.10 christos *got_count -= 1;
4711 1.1 christos }
4712 1.1 christos
4713 1.7 christos *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4714 1.7 christos *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4715 1.7 christos }
4716 1.7 christos
4717 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4718 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4719 1.7 christos }
4720 1.7 christos }
4721 1.7 christos return true;
4722 1.7 christos }
4723 1.10 christos
4724 1.10 christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4726 1.7 christos aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4727 1.7 christos size_dynamic_sections. */
4728 1.10 christos
4729 1.7 christos static bool
4730 1.7 christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4731 1.7 christos {
4732 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4733 1.10 christos do
4734 1.7 christos {
4735 1.7 christos if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4736 1.7 christos return true;
4737 1.7 christos eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4738 1.10 christos } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4739 1.7 christos
4740 1.10 christos return false;
4741 1.10 christos }
4742 1.1 christos
4743 1.1 christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4744 1.1 christos
4745 1.1 christos static bool
4746 1.1 christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4747 1.1 christos {
4748 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4749 1.1 christos
4750 1.10 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4751 1.1 christos if (p->pc_count != 0)
4752 1.1 christos return true;
4753 1.1 christos return false;
4754 1.1 christos }
4755 1.1 christos
4756 1.1 christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4757 1.1 christos regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4758 1.1 christos dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4759 1.1 christos change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4760 1.1 christos understand. */
4761 1.1 christos
4762 1.1 christos static bool
4763 1.1 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4764 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4765 1.1 christos {
4766 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4767 1.7 christos asection *s;
4768 1.1 christos
4769 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
4770 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4771 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
4772 1.1 christos #endif
4773 1.1 christos
4774 1.1 christos /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4775 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4776 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4777 1.10 christos && (h->needs_plt
4778 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4779 1.7 christos || h->is_weakalias
4780 1.7 christos || (h->def_dynamic
4781 1.7 christos && h->ref_regular
4782 1.10 christos && !h->def_regular)));
4783 1.7 christos
4784 1.1 christos /* Deal with function syms. */
4785 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4786 1.1 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4787 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
4788 1.1 christos {
4789 1.1 christos bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4790 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4791 1.1 christos /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4792 1.7 christos function symbol is local. */
4793 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4794 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4795 1.7 christos
4796 1.1 christos /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4797 1.1 christos won't need a .plt entry. */
4798 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4799 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4800 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4801 1.1 christos break;
4802 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
4803 1.1 christos || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4804 1.1 christos && local
4805 1.1 christos && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4806 1.1 christos || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4807 1.1 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4808 1.1 christos {
4809 1.3 christos /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4810 1.1 christos
4811 1.1 christos 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4812 1.1 christos can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4813 1.3 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4814 1.3 christos
4815 1.3 christos 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4816 1.7 christos
4817 1.7 christos 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4818 1.7 christos will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4819 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4820 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
4821 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4822 1.7 christos }
4823 1.7 christos else
4824 1.7 christos {
4825 1.7 christos /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4826 1.10 christos doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4827 1.3 christos executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4828 1.10 christos be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4829 1.3 christos (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4830 1.3 christos through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4831 1.7 christos reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4832 1.7 christos resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4833 1.7 christos than link time. */
4834 1.7 christos if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4835 1.7 christos || (h->non_got_ref
4836 1.7 christos && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4837 1.7 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4838 1.7 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4839 1.10 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4840 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4841 1.3 christos {
4842 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4843 1.10 christos /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4844 1.1 christos isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4845 1.1 christos if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4846 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4847 1.1 christos }
4848 1.1 christos else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4849 1.1 christos /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4850 1.1 christos plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4851 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4852 1.1 christos }
4853 1.7 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4854 1.7 christos /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4855 1.7 christos return true;
4856 1.7 christos }
4857 1.7 christos else
4858 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4859 1.7 christos
4860 1.10 christos /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4861 1.10 christos processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4862 1.1 christos real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4863 1.1 christos if (h->is_weakalias)
4864 1.1 christos {
4865 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4866 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4867 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4868 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4869 1.1 christos if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4870 1.1 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4871 1.3 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4872 1.3 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4873 1.3 christos return true;
4874 1.10 christos }
4875 1.3 christos
4876 1.1 christos /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4877 1.1 christos is not a function. */
4878 1.1 christos
4879 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4880 1.3 christos only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4881 1.3 christos For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4882 1.10 christos be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4883 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4884 1.3 christos {
4885 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4886 1.3 christos return true;
4887 1.3 christos }
4888 1.3 christos
4889 1.3 christos /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4890 1.3 christos GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4891 1.3 christos if (!h->non_got_ref)
4892 1.3 christos {
4893 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4894 1.3 christos return true;
4895 1.3 christos }
4896 1.3 christos
4897 1.10 christos /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4898 1.3 christos .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4899 1.3 christos definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4900 1.3 christos are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4901 1.3 christos if (h->protected_def)
4902 1.10 christos {
4903 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4904 1.7 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4905 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4906 1.1 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4907 1.1 christos && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4908 1.1 christos htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4909 1.1 christos return true;
4910 1.1 christos }
4911 1.1 christos
4912 1.10 christos /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4913 1.1 christos if (info->nocopyreloc)
4914 1.7 christos return true;
4915 1.10 christos
4916 1.1 christos /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4917 1.1 christos we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4918 1.1 christos We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4919 1.1 christos doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4920 1.1 christos relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4921 1.1 christos executable. */
4922 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4923 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4924 1.1 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4925 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
4926 1.1 christos && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4927 1.1 christos return true;
4928 1.1 christos
4929 1.1 christos /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4930 1.1 christos become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4931 1.7 christos an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4932 1.7 christos object will contain position independent code, so all references
4933 1.1 christos from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4934 1.7 christos offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4935 1.1 christos determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4936 1.1 christos both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4937 1.1 christos same memory location for the variable.
4938 1.1 christos
4939 1.1 christos Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4940 1.1 christos must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4941 1.7 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4942 1.7 christos s = htab->dynsbss;
4943 1.7 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4944 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4945 1.1 christos else
4946 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4947 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4948 1.1 christos
4949 1.7 christos if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4950 1.1 christos {
4951 1.1 christos asection *srel;
4952 1.1 christos
4953 1.1 christos /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4954 1.1 christos linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4955 1.7 christos and into the runtime process image. */
4956 1.10 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4957 1.3 christos srel = htab->relsbss;
4958 1.1 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4959 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4960 1.1 christos else
4961 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4962 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4963 1.1 christos srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4964 1.1 christos h->needs_copy = 1;
4965 1.1 christos }
4966 1.10 christos
4967 1.1 christos /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4968 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4969 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4970 1.1 christos }
4971 1.1 christos
4972 1.1 christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4974 1.1 christos xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4975 1.1 christos specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4976 1.1 christos is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4977 1.3 christos xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4978 1.1 christos
4979 1.1 christos static bool
4980 1.1 christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4981 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4982 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4983 1.1 christos {
4984 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4985 1.1 christos size_t len1, len2, len3;
4986 1.1 christos char *name;
4987 1.1 christos const char *stub;
4988 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4989 1.10 christos
4990 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4991 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4992 1.1 christos else
4993 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_call32.";
4994 1.1 christos
4995 1.10 christos len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4996 1.1 christos len2 = strlen (stub);
4997 1.10 christos len3 = 0;
4998 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
4999 1.1 christos len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
5000 1.1 christos name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
5001 1.1 christos if (name == NULL)
5002 1.1 christos return false;
5003 1.1 christos sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
5004 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
5005 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
5006 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
5007 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
5008 1.3 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
5009 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5010 1.10 christos return false;
5011 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5012 1.1 christos {
5013 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5014 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5015 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5016 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5017 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5018 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5019 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5020 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5021 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5022 1.1 christos }
5023 1.1 christos return true;
5024 1.7 christos }
5025 1.7 christos
5026 1.1 christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5027 1.1 christos Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5028 1.1 christos
5029 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
5030 1.1 christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5031 1.1 christos {
5032 1.1 christos bfd_vma where;
5033 1.1 christos unsigned int max_before_header;
5034 1.1 christos
5035 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5036 1.1 christos {
5037 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5038 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5039 1.1 christos }
5040 1.7 christos else
5041 1.7 christos {
5042 1.1 christos max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5043 1.7 christos if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5044 1.7 christos {
5045 1.1 christos where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5046 1.1 christos htab->got_gap -= need;
5047 1.1 christos }
5048 1.1 christos else
5049 1.1 christos {
5050 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5051 1.7 christos && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5052 1.7 christos {
5053 1.7 christos htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5054 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5055 1.7 christos }
5056 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5057 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5058 1.7 christos }
5059 1.7 christos }
5060 1.7 christos return where;
5061 1.7 christos }
5062 1.7 christos
5063 1.7 christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5064 1.9 christos TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5065 1.7 christos
5066 1.7 christos static inline unsigned int
5067 1.7 christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5068 1.7 christos {
5069 1.7 christos unsigned int need;
5070 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5071 1.7 christos need = 4;
5072 1.7 christos else
5073 1.7 christos {
5074 1.10 christos need = 0;
5075 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5076 1.7 christos need += 8;
5077 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5078 1.7 christos need += 4;
5079 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5080 1.7 christos need += 4;
5081 1.7 christos }
5082 1.7 christos return need;
5083 1.7 christos }
5084 1.7 christos
5085 1.7 christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5086 1.7 christos
5087 1.7 christos static bool
5088 1.10 christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5089 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5090 1.10 christos {
5091 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5092 1.10 christos
5093 1.10 christos if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5094 1.10 christos && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5095 1.10 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5096 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5097 1.10 christos && h->dynindx == -1
5098 1.10 christos && !h->forced_local
5099 1.10 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5100 1.10 christos return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5101 1.7 christos return true;
5102 1.7 christos }
5103 1.1 christos
5104 1.1 christos /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
5105 1.10 christos usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry. */
5106 1.1 christos
5107 1.1 christos static inline
5108 1.1 christos bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5109 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5110 1.1 christos {
5111 1.1 christos return (h == NULL
5112 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
5113 1.1 christos || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
5114 1.10 christos }
5115 1.1 christos
5116 1.1 christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5117 1.1 christos
5118 1.3 christos static bool
5119 1.3 christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5120 1.3 christos {
5121 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5122 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5123 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5124 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5125 1.1 christos
5126 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5127 1.1 christos return true;
5128 1.1 christos
5129 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5130 1.10 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5131 1.1 christos if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5132 1.1 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5133 1.7 christos && !eh->elf.def_regular
5134 1.1 christos && eh->elf.protected_def
5135 1.9 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5136 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5137 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5138 1.7 christos {
5139 1.7 christos unsigned int need;
5140 1.7 christos
5141 1.1 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5142 1.1 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5143 1.7 christos return false;
5144 1.1 christos
5145 1.1 christos need = 0;
5146 1.1 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5147 1.1 christos {
5148 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5149 1.9 christos /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5150 1.9 christos always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5151 1.9 christos a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5152 1.10 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5153 1.10 christos else
5154 1.7 christos need += 8;
5155 1.7 christos }
5156 1.7 christos need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5157 1.7 christos if (need == 0)
5158 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5159 1.7 christos else
5160 1.9 christos {
5161 1.9 christos eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5162 1.9 christos if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5163 1.7 christos && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5164 1.7 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
5165 1.3 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5166 1.7 christos && !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
5167 1.7 christos || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5168 1.1 christos && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5169 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5170 1.1 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5171 1.1 christos {
5172 1.1 christos asection *rsec;
5173 1.1 christos
5174 1.7 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5175 1.7 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5176 1.7 christos need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5177 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5178 1.10 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5179 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5180 1.7 christos rsec->size += need;
5181 1.7 christos }
5182 1.7 christos }
5183 1.10 christos }
5184 1.7 christos else
5185 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5186 1.7 christos
5187 1.7 christos /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5188 1.10 christos IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5189 1.7 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5190 1.10 christos && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5191 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5192 1.1 christos
5193 1.1 christos /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5194 1.1 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5195 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5196 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5197 1.1 christos
5198 1.7 christos /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5199 1.1 christos visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5200 1.1 christos else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5201 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5202 1.1 christos
5203 1.1 christos if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5204 1.1 christos ;
5205 1.1 christos
5206 1.1 christos /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5207 1.1 christos dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5208 1.1 christos defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5209 1.1 christos space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5210 1.10 christos changes. */
5211 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5212 1.1 christos {
5213 1.1 christos /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5214 1.1 christos or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5215 1.7 christos generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5216 1.7 christos resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5217 1.7 christos If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5218 1.7 christos then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5219 1.7 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5220 1.7 christos {
5221 1.10 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5222 1.7 christos
5223 1.7 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5224 1.7 christos {
5225 1.10 christos p->count -= p->pc_count;
5226 1.7 christos p->pc_count = 0;
5227 1.7 christos if (p->count == 0)
5228 1.7 christos *pp = p->next;
5229 1.7 christos else
5230 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5231 1.7 christos }
5232 1.7 christos }
5233 1.7 christos
5234 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5235 1.7 christos {
5236 1.7 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5237 1.7 christos
5238 1.10 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5239 1.7 christos {
5240 1.7 christos if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5241 1.7 christos *pp = p->next;
5242 1.7 christos else
5243 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5244 1.7 christos }
5245 1.7 christos }
5246 1.10 christos
5247 1.10 christos if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5248 1.10 christos {
5249 1.10 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5250 1.10 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5251 1.7 christos return false;
5252 1.7 christos }
5253 1.7 christos }
5254 1.7 christos else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5255 1.7 christos {
5256 1.7 christos /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5257 1.7 christos symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5258 1.7 christos dynamic. */
5259 1.7 christos if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
5260 1.10 christos || (h->ref_regular
5261 1.7 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5262 1.7 christos && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
5263 1.10 christos || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
5264 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular
5265 1.7 christos && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5266 1.10 christos && !(h->protected_def
5267 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5268 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5269 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5270 1.10 christos {
5271 1.7 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5272 1.7 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5273 1.7 christos return false;
5274 1.7 christos
5275 1.7 christos if (h->dynindx == -1)
5276 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5277 1.7 christos }
5278 1.7 christos else
5279 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5280 1.7 christos }
5281 1.7 christos
5282 1.7 christos /* Allocate space. */
5283 1.7 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5284 1.10 christos {
5285 1.7 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5286 1.7 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5287 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5288 1.7 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5289 1.7 christos }
5290 1.7 christos
5291 1.7 christos /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5292 1.7 christos We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5293 1.7 christos a) is dynamic, or
5294 1.7 christos b) is an ifunc, or
5295 1.10 christos c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5296 1.7 christos d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5297 1.7 christos if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
5298 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5299 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5300 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt
5301 1.10 christos && h->def_regular
5302 1.10 christos && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5303 1.10 christos && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5304 1.10 christos && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5305 1.10 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5306 1.7 christos {
5307 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5308 1.10 christos bool doneone = false;
5309 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5310 1.7 christos
5311 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5312 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5313 1.7 christos {
5314 1.7 christos asection *s;
5315 1.7 christos bool dyn;
5316 1.7 christos
5317 1.7 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5318 1.7 christos return false;
5319 1.7 christos
5320 1.7 christos dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
5321 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
5322 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5323 1.7 christos {
5324 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5325 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5326 1.7 christos else
5327 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5328 1.7 christos }
5329 1.7 christos
5330 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5331 1.7 christos {
5332 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5333 1.7 christos {
5334 1.7 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5335 1.7 christos s->size += 4;
5336 1.7 christos }
5337 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5338 1.7 christos
5339 1.7 christos if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5340 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5341 1.7 christos else
5342 1.7 christos {
5343 1.7 christos s = htab->glink;
5344 1.7 christos if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5345 1.7 christos {
5346 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5347 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5348 1.10 christos }
5349 1.7 christos if (!doneone
5350 1.7 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5351 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5352 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5353 1.7 christos {
5354 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5355 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5356 1.7 christos }
5357 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5358 1.7 christos
5359 1.7 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5360 1.7 christos && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5361 1.7 christos return false;
5362 1.7 christos }
5363 1.7 christos }
5364 1.7 christos else
5365 1.7 christos {
5366 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5367 1.7 christos {
5368 1.7 christos /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5369 1.7 christos for the special first entry. */
5370 1.7 christos if (s->size == 0)
5371 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5372 1.7 christos
5373 1.7 christos /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5374 1.7 christos parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5375 1.7 christos and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5376 1.7 christos word available at the end. */
5377 1.7 christos plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5378 1.7 christos + (htab->plt_slot_size
5379 1.7 christos * ((s->size
5380 1.7 christos - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5381 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5382 1.7 christos
5383 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5384 1.1 christos file, and we are not generating a shared
5385 1.7 christos library, then set the symbol to this location
5386 1.7 christos in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5387 1.7 christos relocations, and is required to make
5388 1.7 christos function pointers compare as equal between
5389 1.7 christos the normal executable and the shared library. */
5390 1.7 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5391 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5392 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5393 1.7 christos {
5394 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5395 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5396 1.7 christos }
5397 1.1 christos
5398 1.7 christos /* Make room for this entry. */
5399 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5400 1.7 christos /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5401 1.7 christos is allocated. */
5402 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5403 1.7 christos && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5404 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size
5405 1.7 christos > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5406 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5407 1.7 christos }
5408 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5409 1.7 christos }
5410 1.7 christos
5411 1.7 christos /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5412 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5413 1.7 christos {
5414 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5415 1.7 christos {
5416 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5417 1.1 christos {
5418 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5419 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5420 1.7 christos }
5421 1.7 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5422 1.7 christos {
5423 1.7 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5424 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5425 1.7 christos }
5426 1.7 christos }
5427 1.7 christos else
5428 1.7 christos {
5429 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5430 1.7 christos
5431 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5432 1.7 christos {
5433 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5434 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5435 1.7 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5436 1.1 christos {
5437 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset
5438 1.7 christos == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5439 1.7 christos {
5440 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5441 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5442 1.10 christos * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5443 1.7 christos }
5444 1.7 christos
5445 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5446 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5447 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5448 1.7 christos }
5449 1.1 christos
5450 1.7 christos /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5451 1.7 christos .got.plt. */
5452 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5453 1.1 christos }
5454 1.7 christos }
5455 1.1 christos doneone = true;
5456 1.7 christos }
5457 1.7 christos }
5458 1.1 christos else
5459 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5460 1.10 christos
5461 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5462 1.1 christos {
5463 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5464 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5465 1.1 christos }
5466 1.1 christos }
5467 1.1 christos else
5468 1.1 christos {
5469 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5470 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5471 1.1 christos }
5472 1.1 christos
5473 1.1 christos return true;
5474 1.1 christos }
5475 1.1 christos
5476 1.1 christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5477 1.1 christos {
5478 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5479 1.10 christos 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5480 1.3 christos 1, /* CIE version. */
5481 1.1 christos 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5482 1.1 christos 4, /* Code alignment. */
5483 1.1 christos 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5484 1.1 christos 65, /* RA reg. */
5485 1.10 christos 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5486 1.1 christos DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5487 1.1 christos DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5488 1.1 christos };
5489 1.1 christos
5490 1.1 christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5491 1.1 christos
5492 1.1 christos static bool
5493 1.1 christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5494 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
5495 1.1 christos {
5496 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5497 1.1 christos asection *s;
5498 1.3 christos bool relocs;
5499 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
5500 1.1 christos
5501 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
5502 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5503 1.1 christos #endif
5504 1.1 christos
5505 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5506 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5507 1.1 christos
5508 1.1 christos if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5509 1.1 christos {
5510 1.1 christos /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5511 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5512 1.1 christos {
5513 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5514 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5515 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5516 1.1 christos s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5517 1.1 christos }
5518 1.1 christos }
5519 1.1 christos
5520 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5521 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 16;
5522 1.1 christos else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5523 1.10 christos htab->got_header_size = 12;
5524 1.10 christos
5525 1.1 christos /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5526 1.1 christos relocs. */
5527 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5528 1.1 christos {
5529 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5530 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5531 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5532 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5533 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks;
5534 1.1 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5535 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5536 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
5537 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5538 1.1 christos
5539 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5540 1.1 christos continue;
5541 1.1 christos
5542 1.1 christos for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5543 1.1 christos {
5544 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5545 1.1 christos
5546 1.10 christos for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5547 1.1 christos elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5548 1.1 christos p != NULL;
5549 1.1 christos p = p->next)
5550 1.1 christos {
5551 1.1 christos if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5552 1.1 christos && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5553 1.1 christos {
5554 1.1 christos /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5555 1.1 christos it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5556 1.3 christos linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5557 1.7 christos the relocs too. */
5558 1.1 christos }
5559 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5560 1.1 christos && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5561 1.1 christos ".tls_vars") == 0)
5562 1.7 christos {
5563 1.7 christos /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5564 1.7 christos handled specially by the loader. */
5565 1.7 christos }
5566 1.7 christos else if (p->count != 0)
5567 1.1 christos {
5568 1.1 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5569 1.1 christos if (p->ifunc)
5570 1.1 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5571 1.1 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5572 1.1 christos if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5573 1.1 christos & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5574 1.1 christos == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5575 1.1 christos {
5576 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5577 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5578 1.1 christos p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5579 1.1 christos }
5580 1.1 christos }
5581 1.10 christos }
5582 1.10 christos }
5583 1.10 christos
5584 1.10 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5585 1.10 christos if (!local_got)
5586 1.10 christos continue;
5587 1.10 christos
5588 1.10 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5589 1.1 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5590 1.10 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5591 1.10 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5592 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5593 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5594 1.1 christos local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5595 1.7 christos if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
5596 1.7 christos {
5597 1.7 christos local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
5598 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
5599 1.1 christos if (local_syms == NULL)
5600 1.1 christos return false;
5601 1.1 christos }
5602 1.1 christos
5603 1.1 christos for (isym = local_syms;
5604 1.9 christos local_got < end_local_got;
5605 1.9 christos ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
5606 1.10 christos if (*local_got > 0)
5607 1.10 christos {
5608 1.3 christos unsigned int need;
5609 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5610 1.7 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5611 1.9 christos need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5612 1.7 christos if (need == 0)
5613 1.7 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5614 1.7 christos else
5615 1.7 christos {
5616 1.3 christos *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5617 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5618 1.1 christos && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5619 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info))
5620 1.1 christos && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
5621 1.1 christos {
5622 1.10 christos asection *srel;
5623 1.1 christos
5624 1.1 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5625 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5626 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5627 1.7 christos srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5628 1.1 christos srel->size += need;
5629 1.1 christos }
5630 1.10 christos }
5631 1.7 christos }
5632 1.1 christos else
5633 1.1 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5634 1.1 christos
5635 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5636 1.7 christos continue;
5637 1.7 christos
5638 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5639 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5640 1.7 christos for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5641 1.7 christos {
5642 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5643 1.7 christos bool doneone = false;
5644 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5645 1.7 christos
5646 1.1 christos for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5647 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5648 1.1 christos {
5649 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5650 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5651 1.1 christos else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5652 1.1 christos || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5653 1.1 christos {
5654 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5655 1.1 christos continue;
5656 1.7 christos }
5657 1.1 christos else
5658 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5659 1.1 christos
5660 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5661 1.1 christos {
5662 1.1 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5663 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5664 1.7 christos }
5665 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5666 1.7 christos
5667 1.7 christos if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5668 1.7 christos {
5669 1.7 christos s = htab->glink;
5670 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5671 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5672 1.7 christos }
5673 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5674 1.10 christos
5675 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5676 1.1 christos {
5677 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5678 1.1 christos {
5679 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5680 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5681 1.10 christos }
5682 1.10 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5683 1.10 christos {
5684 1.10 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5685 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5686 1.10 christos }
5687 1.10 christos doneone = true;
5688 1.10 christos }
5689 1.1 christos }
5690 1.1 christos else
5691 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5692 1.1 christos }
5693 1.1 christos
5694 1.1 christos if (local_syms != NULL
5695 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
5696 1.1 christos {
5697 1.9 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
5698 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
5699 1.1 christos else
5700 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
5701 1.1 christos }
5702 1.1 christos }
5703 1.7 christos
5704 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5705 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5706 1.1 christos
5707 1.1 christos if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5708 1.1 christos {
5709 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5710 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5711 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5712 1.1 christos }
5713 1.7 christos else
5714 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5715 1.1 christos
5716 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5717 1.1 christos {
5718 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5719 1.1 christos
5720 1.1 christos /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5721 1.3 christos for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5722 1.1 christos or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5723 1.1 christos corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5724 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5725 1.3 christos {
5726 1.3 christos g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5727 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5728 1.3 christos g_o_t += 4;
5729 1.3 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5730 1.3 christos }
5731 1.3 christos
5732 1.3 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5733 1.3 christos }
5734 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5735 1.3 christos {
5736 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5737 1.1 christos
5738 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5739 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5740 1.1 christos }
5741 1.1 christos if (info->emitrelocations)
5742 1.1 christos {
5743 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5744 1.1 christos
5745 1.7 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5746 1.7 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5747 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5748 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5749 1.3 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5750 1.1 christos }
5751 1.1 christos
5752 1.3 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5753 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5754 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5755 1.1 christos {
5756 1.10 christos htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5757 1.1 christos /* Space for the branch table. */
5758 1.10 christos htab->glink->size
5759 1.1 christos += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5760 1.1 christos /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5761 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5762 1.1 christos ? 63 : 15);
5763 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5764 1.1 christos
5765 1.1 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5766 1.1 christos {
5767 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5768 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5769 1.3 christos true, false, false);
5770 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5771 1.1 christos return false;
5772 1.10 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5773 1.1 christos {
5774 1.10 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5775 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5776 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5777 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5778 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5779 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5780 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5781 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5782 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5783 1.1 christos }
5784 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5785 1.3 christos true, false, false);
5786 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5787 1.1 christos return false;
5788 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5789 1.1 christos {
5790 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5791 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5792 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5793 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5794 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5795 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5796 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5797 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5798 1.3 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5799 1.1 christos }
5800 1.1 christos }
5801 1.1 christos }
5802 1.1 christos
5803 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5804 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5805 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5806 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5807 1.1 christos && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5808 1.10 christos {
5809 1.1 christos s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5810 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5811 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5812 1.1 christos {
5813 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5814 1.1 christos if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5815 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5816 1.7 christos }
5817 1.7 christos }
5818 1.1 christos
5819 1.1 christos /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5820 1.1 christos Allocate memory for them. */
5821 1.1 christos relocs = false;
5822 1.1 christos for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5823 1.10 christos {
5824 1.1 christos bool strip_section = true;
5825 1.1 christos
5826 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5827 1.7 christos continue;
5828 1.7 christos
5829 1.1 christos if (s == htab->elf.splt
5830 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5831 1.7 christos {
5832 1.1 christos /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5833 1.7 christos we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5834 1.7 christos It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5835 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5836 1.3 christos strip_section = false;
5837 1.3 christos /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5838 1.3 christos comment below. */
5839 1.3 christos }
5840 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5841 1.1 christos || s == htab->pltlocal
5842 1.3 christos || s == htab->glink
5843 1.1 christos || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5844 1.10 christos || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5845 1.1 christos || s == htab->sbss
5846 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5847 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5848 1.1 christos || s == htab->dynsbss)
5849 1.10 christos {
5850 1.1 christos /* Strip these too. */
5851 1.1 christos }
5852 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5853 1.1 christos || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5854 1.1 christos {
5855 1.1 christos strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5856 1.1 christos }
5857 1.1 christos else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5858 1.1 christos {
5859 1.1 christos if (s->size != 0)
5860 1.1 christos {
5861 1.1 christos /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5862 1.1 christos relocs = true;
5863 1.1 christos
5864 1.1 christos /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5865 1.1 christos to copy relocs into the output file. */
5866 1.1 christos s->reloc_count = 0;
5867 1.1 christos }
5868 1.1 christos }
5869 1.1 christos else
5870 1.1 christos {
5871 1.1 christos /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5872 1.1 christos continue;
5873 1.1 christos }
5874 1.1 christos
5875 1.1 christos if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5876 1.1 christos {
5877 1.1 christos /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5878 1.1 christos output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5879 1.1 christos .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5880 1.1 christos create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5881 1.1 christos before the linker maps input sections to output
5882 1.1 christos sections. The linker does that before
5883 1.10 christos adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5884 1.1 christos function which decides whether anything needs to go
5885 1.1 christos into these sections. */
5886 1.1 christos s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5887 1.1 christos continue;
5888 1.1 christos }
5889 1.1 christos
5890 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5891 1.1 christos continue;
5892 1.1 christos
5893 1.1 christos /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5894 1.1 christos s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5895 1.1 christos if (s->contents == NULL)
5896 1.10 christos return false;
5897 1.10 christos }
5898 1.10 christos
5899 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5900 1.3 christos {
5901 1.3 christos /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5902 1.3 christos values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5903 1.1 christos must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5904 1.1 christos the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5905 1.10 christos dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5906 1.3 christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5907 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5908 1.1 christos
5909 1.3 christos if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5910 1.10 christos relocs))
5911 1.1 christos return false;
5912 1.1 christos
5913 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5914 1.1 christos && htab->glink != NULL
5915 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0)
5916 1.1 christos {
5917 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5918 1.1 christos return false;
5919 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5920 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5921 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5922 1.1 christos && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5923 1.1 christos return false;
5924 1.1 christos }
5925 1.1 christos }
5926 1.1 christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
5927 1.1 christos
5928 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5929 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5930 1.1 christos {
5931 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5932 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
5933 1.1 christos
5934 1.1 christos memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5935 1.1 christos /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5936 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5937 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5938 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
5939 1.1 christos val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5940 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5941 1.3 christos p += 4;
5942 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
5943 1.1 christos val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5944 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5945 1.1 christos p += 4;
5946 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5947 1.1 christos p += 4;
5948 1.1 christos /* .glink size. */
5949 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5950 1.1 christos p += 4;
5951 1.1 christos /* Augmentation. */
5952 1.1 christos p += 1;
5953 1.1 christos
5954 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5955 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5956 1.1 christos {
5957 1.1 christos bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5958 1.1 christos if (adv < 64)
5959 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5960 1.1 christos else if (adv < 256)
5961 1.1 christos {
5962 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5963 1.1 christos *p++ = adv;
5964 1.1 christos }
5965 1.1 christos else if (adv < 65536)
5966 1.1 christos {
5967 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5968 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5969 1.1 christos p += 2;
5970 1.1 christos }
5971 1.1 christos else
5972 1.1 christos {
5973 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5974 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5975 1.10 christos p += 4;
5976 1.1 christos }
5977 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5978 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5979 1.3 christos p++;
5980 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5981 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5982 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5983 1.3 christos }
5984 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5985 1.3 christos == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5986 1.3 christos }
5987 1.3 christos
5988 1.3 christos return true;
5989 1.3 christos }
5990 1.3 christos
5991 1.3 christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5992 1.3 christos if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5993 1.3 christos
5994 1.3 christos static void
5995 1.3 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5996 1.3 christos {
5997 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5998 1.3 christos
5999 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6000 1.3 christos {
6001 1.3 christos asection *s;
6002 1.3 christos
6003 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6004 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6005 1.3 christos {
6006 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6007 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6008 1.3 christos {
6009 1.3 christos sda->def_regular = 0;
6010 1.3 christos /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6011 1.3 christos sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6012 1.3 christos sda->forced_local = 0;
6013 1.3 christos }
6014 1.3 christos }
6015 1.3 christos }
6016 1.3 christos }
6017 1.3 christos
6018 1.1 christos void
6019 1.1 christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6020 1.10 christos {
6021 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6022 1.1 christos
6023 1.1 christos if (htab != NULL)
6024 1.1 christos {
6025 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6026 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6027 1.10 christos }
6028 1.1 christos }
6029 1.1 christos
6030 1.1 christos
6031 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6032 1.1 christos
6033 1.1 christos static bool
6034 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6035 1.1 christos {
6036 1.1 christos if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6037 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
6038 1.1 christos && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6039 1.1 christos || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6040 1.1 christos return false;
6041 1.1 christos
6042 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6043 1.1 christos }
6044 1.1 christos
6045 1.1 christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6047 1.1 christos
6048 1.1 christos /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6049 1.1 christos used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6050 1.1 christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6051 1.1 christos {
6052 1.1 christos 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6053 1.1 christos 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6054 1.1 christos 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6055 1.1 christos 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6056 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6057 1.3 christos 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6058 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6059 1.3 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6060 1.3 christos };
6061 1.3 christos
6062 1.3 christos static const int stub_entry[] =
6063 1.3 christos {
6064 1.3 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6065 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6066 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6067 1.10 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6068 1.1 christos };
6069 1.1 christos
6070 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6071 1.10 christos {
6072 1.1 christos unsigned int workaround_size;
6073 1.3 christos unsigned int picfixup_size;
6074 1.1 christos };
6075 1.3 christos
6076 1.1 christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6077 1.1 christos icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6078 1.1 christos space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6079 1.1 christos add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6080 1.1 christos
6081 1.1 christos static bool
6082 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6083 1.1 christos asection *isec,
6084 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6085 1.1 christos bool *again)
6086 1.1 christos {
6087 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup
6088 1.3 christos {
6089 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6090 1.1 christos asection *tsec;
6091 1.10 christos /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6092 1.1 christos relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6093 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff;
6094 1.1 christos bfd_vma trampoff;
6095 1.10 christos };
6096 1.1 christos
6097 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6098 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6099 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6100 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6101 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6102 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6103 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6104 1.10 christos unsigned changes = 0;
6105 1.1 christos bool workaround_change;
6106 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6107 1.1 christos bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6108 1.1 christos asection *got2;
6109 1.3 christos bool maybe_pasted;
6110 1.10 christos
6111 1.3 christos *again = false;
6112 1.3 christos
6113 1.3 christos /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6114 1.10 christos if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6115 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6116 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6117 1.3 christos || isec->size < 4)
6118 1.3 christos return true;
6119 1.3 christos
6120 1.3 christos /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6121 1.3 christos do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6122 1.3 christos anyway. */
6123 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6124 1.3 christos return true;
6125 1.3 christos
6126 1.3 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6127 1.3 christos if (htab == NULL)
6128 1.3 christos return true;
6129 1.3 christos
6130 1.3 christos isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6131 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6132 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6133 1.10 christos trampbase = isec->size;
6134 1.3 christos
6135 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6136 1.3 christos || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6137 1.3 christos isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6138 1.1 christos
6139 1.1 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6140 1.1 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6141 1.1 christos {
6142 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6143 1.3 christos {
6144 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6145 1.1 christos = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6146 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6147 1.3 christos return false;
6148 1.3 christos }
6149 1.3 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6150 1.3 christos trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6151 1.3 christos }
6152 1.3 christos
6153 1.3 christos maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6154 1.3 christos || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6155 1.3 christos /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6156 1.3 christos trampoff = trampbase;
6157 1.3 christos if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6158 1.3 christos trampoff += 4;
6159 1.1 christos
6160 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6161 1.1 christos picfixup_size = 0;
6162 1.3 christos if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6163 1.3 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6164 1.1 christos {
6165 1.3 christos /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6166 1.3 christos if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6167 1.3 christos {
6168 1.3 christos internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6169 1.3 christos link_info->keep_memory);
6170 1.3 christos if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6171 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6172 1.3 christos }
6173 1.3 christos
6174 1.7 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6175 1.3 christos
6176 1.3 christos irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6177 1.3 christos for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6178 1.3 christos {
6179 1.3 christos unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6180 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff, roff;
6181 1.3 christos asection *tsec;
6182 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6183 1.7 christos size_t insn_offset = 0;
6184 1.3 christos bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6185 1.3 christos bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6186 1.1 christos unsigned long t0;
6187 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6188 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6189 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **plist;
6190 1.3 christos unsigned char sym_type;
6191 1.3 christos
6192 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
6193 1.3 christos {
6194 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6195 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6196 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6197 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6198 1.3 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6199 1.3 christos break;
6200 1.3 christos
6201 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6202 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6203 1.7 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6204 1.7 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6205 1.7 christos break;
6206 1.7 christos
6207 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6208 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6209 1.7 christos break;
6210 1.7 christos continue;
6211 1.3 christos
6212 1.3 christos default:
6213 1.9 christos continue;
6214 1.9 christos }
6215 1.3 christos
6216 1.3 christos /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6217 1.3 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6218 1.1 christos ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6219 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6220 1.3 christos
6221 1.7 christos if (isym != NULL)
6222 1.7 christos {
6223 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6224 1.3 christos ;
6225 1.3 christos else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6226 1.7 christos tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6227 1.7 christos else
6228 1.7 christos continue;
6229 1.3 christos
6230 1.3 christos toff = isym->st_value;
6231 1.3 christos sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6232 1.3 christos }
6233 1.3 christos else
6234 1.3 christos {
6235 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6236 1.3 christos toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6237 1.3 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6238 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6239 1.3 christos {
6240 1.3 christos unsigned long indx;
6241 1.3 christos
6242 1.3 christos indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6243 1.3 christos tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6244 1.3 christos toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6245 1.3 christos }
6246 1.3 christos else
6247 1.3 christos continue;
6248 1.3 christos
6249 1.3 christos /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6250 1.3 christos optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6251 1.3 christos branch stub in that case. */
6252 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6253 1.3 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6254 1.3 christos && irel != internal_relocs)
6255 1.3 christos {
6256 1.3 christos unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6257 1.3 christos unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6258 1.3 christos unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6259 1.3 christos
6260 1.3 christos /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6261 1.3 christos R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6262 1.3 christos on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6263 1.3 christos mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6264 1.3 christos if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6265 1.3 christos {
6266 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6267 1.3 christos
6268 1.3 christos if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6269 1.3 christos {
6270 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6271 1.1 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6272 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6273 1.3 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6274 1.3 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6275 1.1 christos }
6276 1.3 christos }
6277 1.3 christos else
6278 1.3 christos {
6279 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6280 1.3 christos = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6281 1.3 christos
6282 1.3 christos while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6283 1.3 christos || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6284 1.3 christos th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6285 1.3 christos
6286 1.3 christos tls_mask
6287 1.3 christos = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6288 1.3 christos }
6289 1.1 christos
6290 1.3 christos /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6291 1.3 christos optimised away. */
6292 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6293 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6294 1.1 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6295 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6296 1.3 christos continue;
6297 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6298 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6299 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6300 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6301 1.3 christos continue;
6302 1.1 christos }
6303 1.3 christos
6304 1.3 christos sym_type = h->type;
6305 1.3 christos }
6306 1.3 christos
6307 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6308 1.3 christos {
6309 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
6310 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
6311 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
6312 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6313 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6314 1.3 christos picfixup_size += 12;
6315 1.3 christos continue;
6316 1.3 christos }
6317 1.3 christos
6318 1.3 christos /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6319 1.3 christos match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6320 1.3 christos but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6321 1.3 christos destination used here may be incorrect. */
6322 1.3 christos plist = NULL;
6323 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6324 1.3 christos {
6325 1.3 christos /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6326 1.3 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6327 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6328 1.1 christos plist = &h->plt.plist;
6329 1.3 christos }
6330 1.3 christos else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6331 1.3 christos && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6332 1.3 christos {
6333 1.1 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6334 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6335 1.3 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6336 1.3 christos plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6337 1.3 christos }
6338 1.3 christos if (plist != NULL)
6339 1.3 christos {
6340 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
6341 1.3 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
6342 1.3 christos
6343 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6344 1.7 christos addend = irel->r_addend;
6345 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6346 1.3 christos if (ent != NULL)
6347 1.1 christos {
6348 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6349 1.1 christos || h == NULL
6350 1.3 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6351 1.3 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
6352 1.3 christos {
6353 1.3 christos tsec = htab->glink;
6354 1.3 christos toff = ent->glink_offset;
6355 1.3 christos }
6356 1.9 christos else
6357 1.9 christos {
6358 1.9 christos tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6359 1.9 christos toff = ent->plt.offset;
6360 1.9 christos }
6361 1.9 christos }
6362 1.9 christos }
6363 1.9 christos
6364 1.9 christos /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6365 1.9 christos no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6366 1.9 christos branch overflow. */
6367 1.3 christos if (tsec == isec)
6368 1.3 christos continue;
6369 1.3 christos
6370 1.3 christos /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6371 1.3 christos undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6372 1.3 christos support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6373 1.3 christos putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6374 1.3 christos branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6375 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6376 1.3 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6377 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6378 1.3 christos && irel->r_addend != 0)
6379 1.3 christos continue;
6380 1.3 christos
6381 1.3 christos /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6382 1.3 christos SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6383 1.3 christos attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6384 1.3 christos branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6385 1.3 christos reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6386 1.3 christos if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6387 1.3 christos {
6388 1.3 christos /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6389 1.3 christos adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6390 1.9 christos passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6391 1.9 christos relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6392 1.3 christos section symbols have been adjusted.)
6393 1.3 christos
6394 1.3 christos gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6395 1.3 christos sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6396 1.3 christos the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6397 1.3 christos a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6398 1.1 christos offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6399 1.9 christos location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6400 1.9 christos other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6401 1.3 christos a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6402 1.3 christos access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6403 1.3 christos location of interest is just "sym". */
6404 1.3 christos if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6405 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6406 1.1 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6407 1.3 christos
6408 1.3 christos toff
6409 1.3 christos = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6410 1.3 christos elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6411 1.3 christos toff);
6412 1.3 christos
6413 1.3 christos if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6414 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6415 1.3 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6416 1.1 christos }
6417 1.9 christos /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6418 1.9 christos else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6419 1.9 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6420 1.9 christos
6421 1.9 christos /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6422 1.9 christos if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6423 1.9 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6424 1.9 christos || tsec->output_section == NULL
6425 1.9 christos || (tsec->owner != NULL
6426 1.9 christos && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6427 1.3 christos continue;
6428 1.3 christos
6429 1.3 christos roff = irel->r_offset;
6430 1.3 christos
6431 1.3 christos /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6432 1.3 christos relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6433 1.3 christos fixup can be created at final link.
6434 1.3 christos The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6435 1.3 christos of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6436 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6437 1.3 christos && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6438 1.3 christos < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6439 1.3 christos continue;
6440 1.3 christos
6441 1.3 christos /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6442 1.1 christos if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6443 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6444 1.3 christos /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6445 1.3 christos final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6446 1.3 christos || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6447 1.1 christos {
6448 1.3 christos bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6449 1.3 christos
6450 1.3 christos symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6451 1.3 christos reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6452 1.1 christos if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6453 1.3 christos < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6454 1.3 christos continue;
6455 1.3 christos }
6456 1.3 christos
6457 1.3 christos /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6458 1.1 christos for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6459 1.3 christos if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6460 1.3 christos break;
6461 1.3 christos
6462 1.3 christos if (f == NULL)
6463 1.3 christos {
6464 1.3 christos size_t size;
6465 1.3 christos unsigned long stub_rtype;
6466 1.3 christos
6467 1.3 christos val = trampoff - roff;
6468 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6469 1.3 christos /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6470 1.7 christos one. We'll report an error later. */
6471 1.3 christos continue;
6472 1.3 christos
6473 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6474 1.3 christos {
6475 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6476 1.3 christos insn_offset = 12;
6477 1.1 christos }
6478 1.3 christos else
6479 1.3 christos {
6480 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6481 1.3 christos insn_offset = 0;
6482 1.3 christos }
6483 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6484 1.3 christos if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6485 1.3 christos || tsec == htab->glink)
6486 1.3 christos {
6487 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6488 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6489 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6490 1.3 christos }
6491 1.3 christos
6492 1.3 christos /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6493 1.3 christos relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6494 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6495 1.3 christos stub_rtype);
6496 1.3 christos irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6497 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6498 1.1 christos && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6499 1.1 christos irel->r_addend = 0;
6500 1.3 christos
6501 1.3 christos /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6502 1.3 christos f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6503 1.3 christos f->next = branch_fixups;
6504 1.3 christos f->tsec = tsec;
6505 1.3 christos f->toff = toff;
6506 1.1 christos f->trampoff = trampoff;
6507 1.1 christos branch_fixups = f;
6508 1.3 christos
6509 1.3 christos trampoff += size;
6510 1.1 christos changes++;
6511 1.3 christos }
6512 1.3 christos else
6513 1.3 christos {
6514 1.1 christos val = f->trampoff - roff;
6515 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6516 1.1 christos continue;
6517 1.1 christos
6518 1.1 christos /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6519 1.3 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6520 1.3 christos }
6521 1.3 christos
6522 1.3 christos /* Get the section contents. */
6523 1.3 christos if (contents == NULL)
6524 1.3 christos {
6525 1.3 christos /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6526 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6527 1.3 christos contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6528 1.3 christos /* Go get them off disk. */
6529 1.3 christos else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6530 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6531 1.1 christos }
6532 1.3 christos
6533 1.3 christos /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6534 1.3 christos hit_addr = contents + roff;
6535 1.3 christos switch (r_type)
6536 1.3 christos {
6537 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6538 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6539 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6540 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6541 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6542 1.1 christos t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6543 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6544 1.1 christos break;
6545 1.3 christos
6546 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6547 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6548 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6549 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6550 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6551 1.10 christos t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6552 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6553 1.3 christos break;
6554 1.3 christos }
6555 1.3 christos }
6556 1.3 christos
6557 1.3 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6558 1.3 christos {
6559 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6560 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6561 1.3 christos free (f);
6562 1.3 christos }
6563 1.3 christos }
6564 1.3 christos
6565 1.3 christos workaround_change = false;
6566 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff;
6567 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6568 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6569 1.3 christos || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6570 1.3 christos {
6571 1.3 christos bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6572 1.3 christos unsigned int crossings;
6573 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6574 1.3 christos
6575 1.10 christos addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6576 1.3 christos end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6577 1.3 christos addr &= -pagesize;
6578 1.3 christos crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6579 1.1 christos if (crossings != 0)
6580 1.3 christos {
6581 1.3 christos /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6582 1.1 christos not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6583 1.3 christos previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6584 1.3 christos newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6585 1.3 christos newsize += crossings * 16;
6586 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6587 1.3 christos {
6588 1.3 christos relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6589 1.3 christos workaround_change = true;
6590 1.1 christos }
6591 1.3 christos /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6592 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6593 1.1 christos }
6594 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6595 1.1 christos }
6596 1.1 christos
6597 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6598 1.1 christos {
6599 1.1 christos picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6600 1.1 christos if (picfixup_size != 0)
6601 1.1 christos relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6602 1.1 christos newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6603 1.1 christos }
6604 1.1 christos
6605 1.1 christos if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6606 1.1 christos isec->size = newsize;
6607 1.1 christos
6608 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL
6609 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6610 1.1 christos {
6611 1.1 christos if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6612 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6613 1.1 christos else
6614 1.1 christos {
6615 1.1 christos /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6616 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6617 1.1 christos }
6618 1.3 christos }
6619 1.1 christos
6620 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL
6621 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6622 1.1 christos {
6623 1.1 christos if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6624 1.1 christos free (contents);
6625 1.1 christos else
6626 1.1 christos {
6627 1.1 christos /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6628 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6629 1.1 christos }
6630 1.1 christos }
6631 1.1 christos
6632 1.1 christos changes += picfixup_size;
6633 1.1 christos if (changes != 0)
6634 1.1 christos {
6635 1.1 christos /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6636 1.1 christos information for the trampolines. */
6637 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6638 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6639 1.1 christos * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6640 1.1 christos unsigned ix;
6641 1.1 christos
6642 1.1 christos if (!new_relocs)
6643 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6644 1.1 christos memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6645 1.10 christos isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6646 1.1 christos for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6647 1.1 christos {
6648 1.3 christos irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6649 1.10 christos
6650 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6651 1.1 christos }
6652 1.3 christos if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6653 1.3 christos free (internal_relocs);
6654 1.3 christos elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6655 1.3 christos isec->reloc_count += changes;
6656 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6657 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6658 1.10 christos }
6659 1.1 christos else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6660 1.10 christos free (internal_relocs);
6661 1.1 christos
6662 1.10 christos *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6663 1.1 christos return true;
6664 1.10 christos
6665 1.1 christos error_return:
6666 1.1 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6667 1.1 christos {
6668 1.1 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6669 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6670 1.1 christos free (f);
6671 1.1 christos }
6672 1.1 christos if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6673 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6674 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6675 1.1 christos free (contents);
6676 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6677 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs);
6678 1.1 christos return false;
6679 1.1 christos }
6680 1.1 christos
6681 1.1 christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6683 1.1 christos discarded sections. */
6684 1.1 christos
6685 1.1 christos static unsigned int
6686 1.1 christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6687 1.1 christos {
6688 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6689 1.1 christos return 0;
6690 1.1 christos
6691 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6692 1.1 christos return 0;
6693 1.1 christos
6694 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6695 1.1 christos }
6696 1.1 christos
6697 1.1 christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6699 1.1 christos
6700 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
6701 1.1 christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6702 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6703 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6704 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation,
6705 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6706 1.1 christos {
6707 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6708 1.1 christos
6709 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6710 1.1 christos
6711 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6712 1.1 christos {
6713 1.1 christos /* Handle global symbol. */
6714 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6715 1.1 christos
6716 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6717 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6718 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6719 1.1 christos }
6720 1.1 christos else
6721 1.1 christos {
6722 1.1 christos /* Handle local symbol. */
6723 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6724 1.1 christos
6725 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6726 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6727 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6728 1.1 christos }
6729 1.1 christos
6730 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6731 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
6732 1.1 christos lsect);
6733 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6734 1.1 christos
6735 1.1 christos /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6736 1.1 christos as a "written" flag. */
6737 1.1 christos if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6738 1.1 christos {
6739 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6740 1.1 christos relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6741 1.1 christos lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6742 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6743 1.1 christos }
6744 1.1 christos
6745 1.1 christos relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6746 1.1 christos + lsect->section->output_offset
6747 1.1 christos + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6748 1.7 christos - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6749 1.7 christos
6750 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
6751 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
6752 1.1 christos "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6753 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6754 1.1 christos #endif
6755 1.7 christos
6756 1.7 christos return relocation;
6757 1.7 christos }
6758 1.7 christos
6759 1.7 christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6760 1.7 christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6761 1.7 christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6762 1.7 christos
6763 1.7 christos static void
6764 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6765 1.7 christos asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6766 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
6767 1.7 christos {
6768 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6769 1.7 christos bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6770 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt;
6771 1.7 christos unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6772 1.7 christos
6773 1.7 christos if (h != NULL
6774 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6775 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6776 1.7 christos {
6777 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6778 1.1 christos p += 4;
6779 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6780 1.1 christos p += 4;
6781 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6782 1.1 christos p += 4;
6783 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6784 1.1 christos p += 4;
6785 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6786 1.1 christos p += 4;
6787 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6788 1.1 christos p += 4;
6789 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6790 1.1 christos p += 4;
6791 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6792 1.1 christos p += 4;
6793 1.1 christos }
6794 1.1 christos
6795 1.1 christos plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6796 1.1 christos + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6797 1.7 christos + plt_sec->output_offset);
6798 1.1 christos
6799 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6800 1.1 christos {
6801 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
6802 1.1 christos
6803 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6804 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
6805 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6806 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
6807 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6808 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6809 1.1 christos
6810 1.7 christos plt -= got;
6811 1.7 christos
6812 1.7 christos if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6813 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6814 1.7 christos else
6815 1.7 christos {
6816 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6817 1.7 christos p += 4;
6818 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6819 1.1 christos }
6820 1.1 christos }
6821 1.1 christos else
6822 1.1 christos {
6823 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6824 1.1 christos p += 4;
6825 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6826 1.1 christos }
6827 1.1 christos p += 4;
6828 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6829 1.1 christos p += 4;
6830 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6831 1.1 christos p += 4;
6832 1.1 christos while (p < end)
6833 1.1 christos {
6834 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6835 1.1 christos p += 4;
6836 1.1 christos }
6837 1.1 christos }
6838 1.1 christos
6839 1.1 christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6840 1.1 christos
6841 1.1 christos static bool
6842 1.1 christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6843 1.9 christos {
6844 1.1 christos return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6845 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6846 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6847 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6848 1.1 christos }
6849 1.1 christos
6850 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6851 1.1 christos the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6852 1.1 christos REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6853 1.1 christos
6854 1.1 christos unsigned int
6855 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6856 1.1 christos {
6857 1.1 christos unsigned int rtra;
6858 1.1 christos
6859 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6860 1.1 christos return 0;
6861 1.9 christos
6862 1.1 christos if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6863 1.1 christos rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6864 1.9 christos else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6865 1.1 christos rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6866 1.1 christos else
6867 1.9 christos return 0;
6868 1.1 christos
6869 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6870 1.1 christos /* add -> addi. */
6871 1.1 christos insn = 14 << 26;
6872 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6873 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6874 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6875 1.1 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6876 1.1 christos /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6877 1.1 christos insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6878 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6879 1.1 christos /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6880 1.1 christos insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6881 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6882 1.9 christos /* lwax -> lwa. */
6883 1.9 christos insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6884 1.9 christos else
6885 1.9 christos return 0;
6886 1.9 christos insn |= rtra;
6887 1.9 christos return insn;
6888 1.9 christos }
6889 1.9 christos
6890 1.9 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6891 1.9 christos the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6892 1.9 christos thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6893 1.9 christos
6894 1.9 christos unsigned int
6895 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6896 1.9 christos {
6897 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6898 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6899 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6900 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6901 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6902 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6903 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6904 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6905 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6906 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6907 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6908 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6909 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6910 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6911 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6912 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6913 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6914 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
6915 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6916 1.1 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6917 1.1 christos {
6918 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6919 1.10 christos }
6920 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6921 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6922 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6923 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6924 1.9 christos {
6925 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6926 1.1 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6927 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6928 1.10 christos insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6929 1.1 christos }
6930 1.1 christos else
6931 1.9 christos insn = 0;
6932 1.9 christos return insn;
6933 1.3 christos }
6934 1.1 christos
6935 1.1 christos static bool
6936 1.1 christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6937 1.1 christos {
6938 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6939 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6940 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6941 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6942 1.1 christos }
6943 1.1 christos
6944 1.1 christos static bool
6945 1.1 christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6946 1.1 christos {
6947 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6948 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6949 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) == 1));
6950 1.1 christos }
6951 1.1 christos
6952 1.1 christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6953 1.1 christos to handle the relocations for a section.
6954 1.1 christos
6955 1.1 christos The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6956 1.1 christos actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6957 1.1 christos zero.
6958 1.1 christos
6959 1.1 christos This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6960 1.1 christos necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6961 1.1 christos relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6962 1.1 christos necessary.
6963 1.1 christos
6964 1.1 christos This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6965 1.10 christos address or the reloc symbol index.
6966 1.1 christos
6967 1.1 christos LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6968 1.1 christos
6969 1.1 christos LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6970 1.1 christos corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6971 1.1 christos
6972 1.1 christos The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6973 1.1 christos via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6974 1.1 christos
6975 1.1 christos When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6976 1.1 christos STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6977 1.1 christos going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6978 1.1 christos section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6979 1.3 christos accordingly. */
6980 1.1 christos
6981 1.1 christos static int
6982 1.3 christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6983 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
6984 1.10 christos bfd *input_bfd,
6985 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
6986 1.10 christos bfd_byte *contents,
6987 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6988 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6989 1.1 christos asection **local_sections)
6990 1.1 christos {
6991 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6992 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6993 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6994 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6995 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6996 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6997 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6998 1.9 christos asection *got2;
6999 1.9 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7000 1.9 christos bool ret = true;
7001 1.10 christos bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7002 1.9 christos bool is_vxworks_tls;
7003 1.9 christos unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7004 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7005 1.1 christos
7006 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
7007 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7008 1.1 christos "%ld relocations%s",
7009 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section,
7010 1.1 christos (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7011 1.1 christos (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7012 1.1 christos #endif
7013 1.1 christos
7014 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7015 1.1 christos {
7016 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7017 1.1 christos return false;
7018 1.1 christos }
7019 1.3 christos
7020 1.3 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7021 1.3 christos
7022 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7023 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7024 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7025 1.1 christos
7026 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7027 1.1 christos local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7028 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7029 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7030 1.1 christos /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7031 1.1 christos specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7032 1.1 christos is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7033 1.1 christos && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7034 1.1 christos ".tls_vars"));
7035 1.1 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7036 1.10 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7037 1.10 christos rel = wrel = relocs;
7038 1.1 christos relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7039 1.7 christos for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7040 1.3 christos {
7041 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7042 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend;
7043 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7044 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7045 1.1 christos asection *sec;
7046 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7047 1.10 christos const char *sym_name;
7048 1.10 christos reloc_howto_type *howto;
7049 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
7050 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation;
7051 1.1 christos bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7052 1.1 christos bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7053 1.1 christos bool warned;
7054 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7055 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7056 1.1 christos struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7057 1.1 christos
7058 1.1 christos again:
7059 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7060 1.1 christos sym = NULL;
7061 1.10 christos sec = NULL;
7062 1.3 christos h = NULL;
7063 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7064 1.1 christos warned = false;
7065 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7066 1.3 christos
7067 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7068 1.1 christos {
7069 1.1 christos sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7070 1.1 christos sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7071 1.1 christos sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7072 1.1 christos
7073 1.1 christos relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7074 1.1 christos }
7075 1.1 christos else
7076 1.1 christos {
7077 1.1 christos bool ignored;
7078 1.1 christos
7079 1.3 christos RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7080 1.3 christos r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7081 1.9 christos h, sec, relocation,
7082 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7083 1.3 christos
7084 1.3 christos sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7085 1.3 christos }
7086 1.3 christos
7087 1.7 christos if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7088 1.3 christos {
7089 1.3 christos /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7090 1.3 christos or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7091 1.3 christos section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7092 1.3 christos howto = NULL;
7093 1.3 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7094 1.3 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7095 1.1 christos
7096 1.1 christos _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7097 1.3 christos contents, rel->r_offset);
7098 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7099 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = 0;
7100 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = 0;
7101 1.1 christos
7102 1.1 christos /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7103 1.1 christos symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7104 1.1 christos non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7105 1.1 christos eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7106 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7107 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7108 1.3 christos wrel--;
7109 1.3 christos
7110 1.3 christos continue;
7111 1.1 christos }
7112 1.1 christos
7113 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7114 1.1 christos {
7115 1.1 christos if (got2 != NULL
7116 1.1 christos && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7117 1.1 christos && rel->r_addend != 0)
7118 1.1 christos {
7119 1.1 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7120 1.1 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7121 1.1 christos rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7122 1.1 christos }
7123 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7124 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7125 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7126 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7127 1.1 christos }
7128 1.1 christos
7129 1.1 christos /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7130 1.1 christos based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7131 1.1 christos RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7132 1.1 christos for the final instruction stream. */
7133 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7134 1.1 christos tls_gd = 0;
7135 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7136 1.1 christos tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7137 1.1 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7138 1.1 christos {
7139 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7140 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
7141 1.1 christos local_plt
7142 1.1 christos = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7143 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7144 1.1 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7145 1.1 christos }
7146 1.1 christos
7147 1.1 christos /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7148 1.1 christos if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7149 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7150 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7151 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7152 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7153 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7154 1.7 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7155 1.3 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7156 1.1 christos abort ();
7157 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7158 1.7 christos {
7159 1.3 christos default:
7160 1.1 christos break;
7161 1.1 christos
7162 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7163 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7164 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7165 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7166 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7167 1.10 christos {
7168 1.10 christos bfd_vma insn;
7169 1.1 christos
7170 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7171 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7172 1.7 christos insn &= 31 << 21;
7173 1.1 christos insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7174 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7175 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7176 1.7 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7177 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7178 1.1 christos }
7179 1.1 christos break;
7180 1.1 christos
7181 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7182 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7183 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7184 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7185 1.1 christos {
7186 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7187 1.1 christos
7188 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7189 1.10 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7190 1.10 christos if (insn == 0)
7191 1.1 christos abort ();
7192 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7193 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7194 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7195 1.1 christos
7196 1.10 christos /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7197 1.10 christos PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7198 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7199 1.1 christos }
7200 1.1 christos break;
7201 1.1 christos
7202 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7203 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7204 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7205 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7206 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7207 1.1 christos goto tls_gdld_hi;
7208 1.1 christos break;
7209 1.1 christos
7210 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7211 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7212 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7213 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7214 1.1 christos {
7215 1.9 christos tls_gdld_hi:
7216 1.10 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7217 1.10 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7218 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7219 1.1 christos else
7220 1.1 christos {
7221 1.1 christos rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7222 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7223 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7224 1.10 christos }
7225 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7226 1.1 christos }
7227 1.1 christos break;
7228 1.1 christos
7229 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7230 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7231 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7232 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7233 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7234 1.1 christos goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7235 1.1 christos break;
7236 1.9 christos
7237 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7238 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7239 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7240 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7241 1.3 christos {
7242 1.3 christos unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7243 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset;
7244 1.3 christos
7245 1.7 christos tls_ldgd_opt:
7246 1.3 christos offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7247 1.1 christos /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7248 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7249 1.1 christos stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7250 1.3 christos reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7251 1.9 christos the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7252 1.10 christos if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7253 1.10 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7254 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7255 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
7256 1.1 christos offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7257 1.7 christos /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7258 1.1 christos the destination reg. It may be something other than
7259 1.1 christos the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7260 1.1 christos intervening code. */
7261 1.1 christos insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7262 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7263 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7264 1.1 christos {
7265 1.1 christos /* IE */
7266 1.3 christos insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7267 1.3 christos insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7268 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7269 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7270 1.1 christos {
7271 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7272 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7273 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7274 1.1 christos }
7275 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7276 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7277 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7278 1.1 christos }
7279 1.1 christos else
7280 1.1 christos {
7281 1.1 christos /* LE */
7282 1.1 christos insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7283 1.1 christos insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7284 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7285 1.1 christos {
7286 1.10 christos /* Was an LD reloc. */
7287 1.10 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7288 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7289 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7290 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7291 1.1 christos break;
7292 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7293 1.7 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7294 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7295 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7296 1.7 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7297 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7298 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7299 1.1 christos }
7300 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7301 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7302 1.3 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7303 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7304 1.1 christos {
7305 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7306 1.1 christos rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7307 1.1 christos rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7308 1.7 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7309 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7310 1.10 christos }
7311 1.1 christos }
7312 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7313 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7314 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7315 1.7 christos {
7316 1.7 christos /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7317 1.7 christos in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7318 1.7 christos goto again;
7319 1.7 christos }
7320 1.7 christos }
7321 1.7 christos break;
7322 1.9 christos
7323 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7324 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7325 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7326 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7327 1.1 christos {
7328 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7329 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7330 1.1 christos
7331 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7332 1.1 christos {
7333 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7334 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7335 1.1 christos break;
7336 1.7 christos }
7337 1.1 christos
7338 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7339 1.1 christos {
7340 1.1 christos /* IE */
7341 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7342 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7343 1.1 christos }
7344 1.7 christos else
7345 1.10 christos {
7346 1.10 christos /* LE */
7347 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7348 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7349 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7350 1.7 christos }
7351 1.7 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7352 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7353 1.7 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7354 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7355 1.7 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7356 1.7 christos }
7357 1.1 christos break;
7358 1.1 christos
7359 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7360 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7361 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7362 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7363 1.1 christos {
7364 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7365 1.1 christos
7366 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7367 1.1 christos {
7368 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7369 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7370 1.1 christos break;
7371 1.1 christos }
7372 1.1 christos
7373 1.7 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7374 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7375 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7376 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7377 1.1 christos break;
7378 1.3 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7379 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7380 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7381 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7382 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7383 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7384 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7385 1.1 christos
7386 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7387 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7388 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7389 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7390 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7391 1.1 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7392 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7393 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7394 1.7 christos goto again;
7395 1.1 christos }
7396 1.1 christos break;
7397 1.1 christos }
7398 1.1 christos
7399 1.10 christos /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7400 1.10 christos branch_bit = 0;
7401 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
7402 1.1 christos {
7403 1.10 christos default:
7404 1.10 christos break;
7405 1.10 christos
7406 1.1 christos /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7407 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7408 1.10 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7409 1.10 christos branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7410 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */
7411 1.10 christos
7412 1.10 christos /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7413 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7414 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7415 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7416 1.10 christos {
7417 1.7 christos unsigned int insn;
7418 1.7 christos
7419 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7420 1.10 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7421 1.10 christos insn |= branch_bit;
7422 1.10 christos
7423 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset
7424 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset
7425 1.10 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
7426 1.10 christos
7427 1.10 christos /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7428 1.10 christos if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7429 1.10 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7430 1.10 christos
7431 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7432 1.10 christos }
7433 1.10 christos break;
7434 1.10 christos
7435 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7436 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7437 1.10 christos {
7438 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
7439 1.10 christos
7440 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7441 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7442 1.10 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7443 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7444 1.1 christos {
7445 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7446 1.3 christos {
7447 1.3 christos /* Convert addis to lis. */
7448 1.3 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7449 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7450 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7451 1.3 christos }
7452 1.3 christos }
7453 1.3 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7454 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7455 1.3 christos (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7456 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7457 1.3 christos "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7458 1.10 christos }
7459 1.10 christos break;
7460 1.3 christos }
7461 1.7 christos
7462 1.3 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7463 1.9 christos && h != NULL
7464 1.3 christos && !h->def_regular
7465 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
7466 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7467 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7468 1.3 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7469 1.3 christos {
7470 1.3 christos /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7471 1.3 christos variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7472 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
7473 1.3 christos
7474 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
7475 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7476 1.3 christos {
7477 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7478 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7479 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7480 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7481 1.3 christos {
7482 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p;
7483 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7484 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_addr;
7485 1.3 christos
7486 1.3 christos p = (contents + input_section->size
7487 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size
7488 1.3 christos - relax_info->picfixup_size
7489 1.7 christos + picfixup_size);
7490 1.7 christos off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7491 1.3 christos if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7492 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7493 1.3 christos (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7494 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7495 1.3 christos
7496 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7497 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7498 1.3 christos got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7499 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7500 1.3 christos + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7501 1.3 christos wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7502 1.3 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7503 1.3 christos wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7504 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7505 1.3 christos insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7506 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7507 1.3 christos
7508 1.3 christos /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7509 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7510 1.3 christos insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7511 1.3 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7512 1.3 christos insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7513 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7514 1.3 christos
7515 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7516 1.7 christos picfixup_size += 12;
7517 1.7 christos
7518 1.7 christos /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7519 1.7 christos output is reasonable. */
7520 1.3 christos memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7521 1.3 christos wrel++, rel++;
7522 1.10 christos rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7523 1.10 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7524 1.10 christos rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7525 1.3 christos
7526 1.7 christos /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7527 1.3 christos dynamic reloc. */
7528 1.9 christos r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7529 1.9 christos }
7530 1.9 christos else
7531 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
7532 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7533 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7534 1.9 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7535 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7536 1.9 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7537 1.9 christos }
7538 1.9 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
7539 1.9 christos && offset_in_range (input_section,
7540 1.9 christos rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7541 1.9 christos {
7542 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7543 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7544 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7545 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7546 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7547 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7548 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7549 1.10 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7550 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7551 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7552 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7553 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7554 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7555 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7556 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7557 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7558 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7559 1.3 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
7560 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7561 1.3 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7562 1.1 christos {
7563 1.10 christos /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7564 1.1 christos relocation = 0;
7565 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7566 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7567 1.1 christos }
7568 1.1 christos else
7569 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
7570 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7571 1.1 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7572 1.1 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7573 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7574 1.1 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7575 1.1 christos }
7576 1.1 christos }
7577 1.1 christos
7578 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
7579 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7580 1.1 christos {
7581 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
7582 1.1 christos
7583 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7584 1.3 christos {
7585 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7586 1.7 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7587 1.7 christos }
7588 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7589 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7590 1.1 christos {
7591 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7592 1.7 christos
7593 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7594 1.7 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7595 1.7 christos ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7596 1.1 christos }
7597 1.1 christos
7598 1.1 christos ent = NULL;
7599 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL
7600 1.1 christos && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7601 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7602 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7603 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7604 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7605 1.7 christos {
7606 1.7 christos addend = 0;
7607 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7608 1.7 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7609 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7610 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7611 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7612 1.7 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7613 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7614 1.7 christos }
7615 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL)
7616 1.7 christos {
7617 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7618 1.7 christos && ent->sec != got2
7619 1.7 christos && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7620 1.7 christos && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7621 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7622 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1))
7623 1.10 christos {
7624 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7625 1.1 christos for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7626 1.3 christos finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7627 1.3 christos apparently are using code compiled with
7628 1.1 christos -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7629 1.1 christos gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7630 1.1 christos whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7631 1.1 christos is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7632 1.7 christos into .got2). */
7633 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7634 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7635 1.1 christos (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7636 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7637 1.1 christos }
7638 1.1 christos
7639 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7640 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7641 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7642 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7643 1.7 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
7644 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7645 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
7646 1.1 christos + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7647 1.1 christos else
7648 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7649 1.10 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7650 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset);
7651 1.10 christos }
7652 1.10 christos }
7653 1.10 christos
7654 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7655 1.10 christos save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7656 1.10 christos howto = NULL;
7657 1.1 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7658 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7659 1.10 christos
7660 1.3 christos tls_type = 0;
7661 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7662 1.1 christos {
7663 1.1 christos default:
7664 1.1 christos de_fault:
7665 1.1 christos if (howto)
7666 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7667 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7668 1.1 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
7669 1.3 christos else
7670 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7671 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
7672 1.1 christos input_bfd, r_type);
7673 1.1 christos
7674 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7675 1.1 christos ret = false;
7676 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7677 1.1 christos
7678 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
7679 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7680 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7681 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7682 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7683 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7684 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7685 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7686 1.1 christos
7687 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7688 1.1 christos address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7689 1.1 christos symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7690 1.1 christos symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7691 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7692 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7693 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7694 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7695 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7696 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7697 1.1 christos
7698 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7699 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7700 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7701 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7702 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7703 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7704 1.1 christos
7705 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7706 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7707 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7708 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7709 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7710 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7711 1.1 christos
7712 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7713 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7714 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7715 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7716 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7717 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7718 1.1 christos
7719 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
7720 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7721 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7722 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7723 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7724 1.1 christos dogot:
7725 1.7 christos {
7726 1.7 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7727 1.7 christos offset table. */
7728 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7729 1.1 christos bfd_vma *offp;
7730 1.1 christos unsigned long indx;
7731 1.1 christos
7732 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7733 1.1 christos abort ();
7734 1.1 christos
7735 1.1 christos indx = 0;
7736 1.1 christos if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7737 1.10 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7738 1.1 christos offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7739 1.1 christos else if (h != NULL)
7740 1.1 christos {
7741 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7742 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
7743 1.1 christos || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7744 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7745 1.1 christos /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7746 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7747 1.1 christos locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7748 1.1 christos because of a version file. */
7749 1.1 christos ;
7750 1.1 christos else
7751 1.1 christos {
7752 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
7753 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7754 1.1 christos }
7755 1.1 christos offp = &h->got.offset;
7756 1.7 christos }
7757 1.7 christos else
7758 1.9 christos {
7759 1.7 christos if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7760 1.1 christos abort ();
7761 1.1 christos offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7762 1.1 christos }
7763 1.9 christos
7764 1.9 christos /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7765 1.1 christos least significant bit to record whether we have already
7766 1.1 christos processed this entry. */
7767 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7768 1.1 christos if ((off & 1) != 0)
7769 1.1 christos off &= ~1;
7770 1.1 christos else
7771 1.1 christos {
7772 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7773 1.1 christos ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7774 1.1 christos | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7775 1.1 christos : 0);
7776 1.1 christos
7777 1.1 christos if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7778 1.1 christos tls_m = TLS_LD;
7779 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7780 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7781 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7782 1.1 christos
7783 1.1 christos /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7784 1.1 christos Initialize them all. */
7785 1.1 christos do
7786 1.1 christos {
7787 1.1 christos int tls_ty = 0;
7788 1.9 christos
7789 1.1 christos if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7790 1.1 christos {
7791 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7792 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7793 1.1 christos }
7794 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7795 1.7 christos {
7796 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7797 1.7 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7798 1.9 christos }
7799 1.9 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7800 1.7 christos {
7801 1.10 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7802 1.10 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7803 1.10 christos }
7804 1.10 christos else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7805 1.1 christos {
7806 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7807 1.1 christos tls_m = 0;
7808 1.1 christos }
7809 1.3 christos
7810 1.7 christos /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7811 1.7 christos if (indx != 0
7812 1.7 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7813 1.7 christos && (h == NULL
7814 1.7 christos || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7815 1.7 christos && !(tls_ty != 0
7816 1.7 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
7817 1.7 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7818 1.7 christos && (h != NULL
7819 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
7820 1.1 christos : sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
7821 1.1 christos {
7822 1.1 christos asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7823 1.1 christos bfd_byte * loc;
7824 1.1 christos
7825 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
7826 1.1 christos {
7827 1.1 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7828 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
7829 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7830 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
7831 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7832 1.1 christos }
7833 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7834 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7835 1.1 christos + off);
7836 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7837 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7838 1.1 christos {
7839 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7840 1.1 christos if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7841 1.1 christos {
7842 1.1 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7843 1.1 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7844 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7845 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7846 1.1 christos &outrel, loc);
7847 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += 4;
7848 1.1 christos outrel.r_info
7849 1.1 christos = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7850 1.3 christos }
7851 1.3 christos }
7852 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7853 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7854 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7855 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7856 1.1 christos else if (indx != 0)
7857 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7858 1.1 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
7859 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7860 1.1 christos else
7861 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7862 1.1 christos if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7863 1.1 christos {
7864 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7865 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7866 1.1 christos {
7867 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7868 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7869 1.7 christos else
7870 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7871 1.3 christos }
7872 1.3 christos }
7873 1.3 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7874 1.3 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7875 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7876 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7877 1.7 christos }
7878 1.7 christos
7879 1.7 christos /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7880 1.3 christos emitting a reloc. */
7881 1.3 christos else
7882 1.1 christos {
7883 1.7 christos bfd_vma value = relocation;
7884 1.1 christos
7885 1.7 christos if (tls_ty != 0)
7886 1.7 christos {
7887 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7888 1.1 christos value = 0;
7889 1.1 christos else
7890 1.7 christos {
7891 1.7 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7892 1.1 christos value = 0;
7893 1.1 christos else
7894 1.1 christos value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7895 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7896 1.1 christos value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7897 1.1 christos }
7898 1.1 christos
7899 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7900 1.1 christos {
7901 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7902 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7903 1.1 christos value = 1;
7904 1.1 christos }
7905 1.1 christos }
7906 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7907 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7908 1.1 christos }
7909 1.1 christos
7910 1.1 christos off += 4;
7911 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7912 1.9 christos off += 4;
7913 1.1 christos }
7914 1.1 christos while (tls_m != 0);
7915 1.1 christos
7916 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7917 1.1 christos *offp = off | 1;
7918 1.1 christos }
7919 1.1 christos
7920 1.1 christos if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7921 1.1 christos abort ();
7922 1.1 christos
7923 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7924 1.1 christos {
7925 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7926 1.1 christos {
7927 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7928 1.3 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7929 1.3 christos off += 8;
7930 1.3 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7931 1.7 christos {
7932 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7933 1.1 christos off += 8;
7934 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7935 1.1 christos {
7936 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7937 1.1 christos off += 4;
7938 1.1 christos }
7939 1.1 christos }
7940 1.1 christos }
7941 1.1 christos }
7942 1.7 christos
7943 1.7 christos /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7944 1.1 christos if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7945 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7946 1.1 christos
7947 1.1 christos relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7948 1.3 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7949 1.1 christos + off
7950 1.3 christos - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7951 1.1 christos
7952 1.1 christos /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7953 1.1 christos x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7954 1.1 christos generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7955 1.1 christos got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7956 1.6 christos if (addend != 0)
7957 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7958 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7959 1.6 christos (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7960 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7961 1.10 christos howto->name,
7962 1.3 christos sym_name);
7963 1.1 christos }
7964 1.7 christos break;
7965 1.7 christos
7966 1.7 christos /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7967 1.7 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7968 1.7 christos /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7969 1.7 christos at a symbol not in this object. */
7970 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
7971 1.7 christos {
7972 1.7 christos (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7973 1.7 christos h->root.root.string,
7974 1.7 christos input_bfd,
7975 1.7 christos input_section,
7976 1.7 christos rel->r_offset,
7977 1.7 christos true);
7978 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
7979 1.1 christos }
7980 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7981 1.1 christos {
7982 1.1 christos /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7983 1.1 christos the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7984 1.1 christos seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7985 1.3 christos stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7986 1.3 christos access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7987 1.1 christos local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7988 1.1 christos -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7989 1.1 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7990 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7991 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7992 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7993 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
7994 1.1 christos }
7995 1.1 christos break;
7996 1.1 christos
7997 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7998 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7999 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8000 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8001 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8002 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8003 1.1 christos break;
8004 1.1 christos
8005 1.7 christos /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8006 1.1 christos object. */
8007 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8008 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8009 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8010 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8011 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
8012 1.3 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8013 1.1 christos && h->dynindx == -1
8014 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
8015 1.7 christos {
8016 1.1 christos /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8017 1.1 christos resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8018 1.1 christos code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8019 1.3 christos defined before using them. */
8020 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8021 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8022 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8023 1.1 christos if (insn != 0)
8024 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8025 1.3 christos break;
8026 1.1 christos }
8027 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8028 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8029 1.1 christos /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8030 1.1 christos libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8031 1.1 christos DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8032 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8033 1.1 christos
8034 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8035 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8036 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8037 1.3 christos goto dodyn;
8038 1.1 christos
8039 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8040 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8041 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8042 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8043 1.1 christos
8044 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8045 1.1 christos relocation = 1;
8046 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8047 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8048 1.1 christos
8049 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
8050 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8051 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8052 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8053 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8054 1.1 christos break;
8055 1.1 christos
8056 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
8057 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8058 1.1 christos break;
8059 1.1 christos /* fall through */
8060 1.1 christos
8061 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8062 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8065 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8066 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8067 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8068 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8069 1.1 christos
8070 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8071 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8072 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8073 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
8074 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
8075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8077 1.1 christos /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8078 1.1 christos handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8079 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8080 1.1 christos || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8081 1.7 christos break;
8082 1.7 christos /* fall through */
8083 1.10 christos
8084 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8085 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8086 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8087 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8088 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8089 1.1 christos break;
8090 1.3 christos /* fall through */
8091 1.3 christos
8092 1.7 christos dodyn:
8093 1.7 christos if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8094 1.1 christos || is_vxworks_tls)
8095 1.1 christos break;
8096 1.1 christos
8097 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8098 1.1 christos ? ((h == NULL
8099 1.1 christos || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8100 1.1 christos && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8101 1.1 christos || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8102 1.1 christos : (h != NULL
8103 1.1 christos && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8104 1.1 christos {
8105 1.1 christos int skip;
8106 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
8107 1.1 christos asection *sreloc;
8108 1.1 christos long indx = 0;
8109 1.1 christos
8110 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8111 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8112 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
8113 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
8114 1.9 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8115 1.9 christos #endif
8116 1.9 christos
8117 1.9 christos /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8118 1.9 christos are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8119 1.9 christos time. */
8120 1.9 christos skip = 0;
8121 1.9 christos outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8122 1.1 christos input_section,
8123 1.1 christos rel->r_offset);
8124 1.7 christos if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8125 1.1 christos || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8126 1.7 christos skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8127 1.7 christos outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8128 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset);
8129 1.7 christos
8130 1.1 christos /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8131 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8132 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8133 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8134 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8135 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8136 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8137 1.1 christos
8138 1.1 christos if (skip)
8139 1.1 christos memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8140 1.1 christos else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8141 1.1 christos {
8142 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
8143 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8144 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8145 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8146 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8147 1.1 christos }
8148 1.1 christos else
8149 1.1 christos {
8150 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8151 1.1 christos
8152 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8153 1.7 christos {
8154 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8155 1.1 christos {
8156 1.1 christos /* If we get here when building a static
8157 1.1 christos executable, then the libc startup function
8158 1.1 christos responsible for applying indirect function
8159 1.10 christos relocations is going to complain about
8160 1.1 christos the reloc type.
8161 1.1 christos If we get here when building a dynamic
8162 1.1 christos executable, it will be because we have
8163 1.1 christos a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8164 1.1 christos will set the text segment writable and
8165 1.1 christos non-executable to apply text relocations.
8166 1.10 christos So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8167 1.1 christos indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8168 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8169 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8170 1.1 christos (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8171 1.1 christos "function %s unsupported\n"),
8172 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8173 1.1 christos howto->name,
8174 1.1 christos sym_name);
8175 1.1 christos ret = false;
8176 1.1 christos }
8177 1.1 christos else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8178 1.1 christos ;
8179 1.9 christos else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8180 1.9 christos {
8181 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8182 1.9 christos ret = false;
8183 1.9 christos }
8184 1.9 christos else
8185 1.1 christos {
8186 1.1 christos asection *osec;
8187 1.9 christos
8188 1.9 christos /* We are turning this relocation into one
8189 1.9 christos against a section symbol. It would be
8190 1.9 christos proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8191 1.9 christos osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8192 1.9 christos but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8193 1.1 christos FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8194 1.9 christos osec = sec->output_section;
8195 1.9 christos if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8196 1.9 christos {
8197 1.9 christos osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8198 1.9 christos indx = 0;
8199 1.9 christos }
8200 1.1 christos else
8201 1.1 christos {
8202 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8203 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
8204 1.1 christos {
8205 1.1 christos osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8206 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8207 1.1 christos }
8208 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8209 1.1 christos }
8210 1.7 christos
8211 1.7 christos /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8212 1.7 christos Don't leave the symbol value in the
8213 1.7 christos addend for them. */
8214 1.7 christos if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8215 1.7 christos outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8216 1.7 christos }
8217 1.7 christos
8218 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8219 1.7 christos }
8220 1.10 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8221 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8222 1.1 christos else
8223 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8224 1.1 christos }
8225 1.1 christos
8226 1.1 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8227 1.3 christos if (ifunc)
8228 1.1 christos {
8229 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8230 1.7 christos if (indx == 0)
8231 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8232 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
8233 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8234 1.1 christos }
8235 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
8236 1.1 christos return false;
8237 1.1 christos
8238 1.1 christos loc = sreloc->contents;
8239 1.1 christos loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8240 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8241 1.1 christos
8242 1.1 christos if (skip == -1)
8243 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8244 1.1 christos
8245 1.1 christos /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8246 1.1 christos so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8247 1.1 christos if (!skip)
8248 1.1 christos {
8249 1.3 christos relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8250 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8251 1.1 christos break;
8252 1.1 christos }
8253 1.1 christos }
8254 1.1 christos break;
8255 1.1 christos
8256 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8257 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8258 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
8259 1.7 christos {
8260 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8261 1.1 christos bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8262 1.1 christos
8263 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8264 1.1 christos {
8265 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8266 1.10 christos got2_addend = addend;
8267 1.10 christos addend = 0;
8268 1.10 christos }
8269 1.10 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8270 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8271 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8272 1.10 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8273 1.10 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8274 1.10 christos else
8275 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8276 1.3 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8277 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8278 1.10 christos }
8279 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */
8280 1.10 christos
8281 1.10 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
8282 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8283 1.10 christos ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
8284 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
8285 1.10 christos : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
8286 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
8287 1.10 christos {
8288 1.10 christos const int *stub;
8289 1.10 christos size_t size;
8290 1.10 christos size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8291 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
8292 1.10 christos
8293 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8294 1.1 christos {
8295 1.10 christos relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8296 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset
8297 1.10 christos + rel->r_offset - 4);
8298 1.3 christos stub = shared_stub_entry;
8299 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8300 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8301 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8302 1.10 christos stub += 3;
8303 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8304 1.10 christos }
8305 1.10 christos else
8306 1.10 christos {
8307 1.10 christos stub = stub_entry;
8308 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8309 1.10 christos }
8310 1.10 christos
8311 1.10 christos relocation += addend;
8312 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8313 1.10 christos relocation = 0;
8314 1.10 christos
8315 1.10 christos /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8316 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8317 1.10 christos insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8318 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8319 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8320 1.10 christos
8321 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8322 1.10 christos insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8323 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8324 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8325 1.10 christos size -= 2;
8326 1.10 christos
8327 1.10 christos while (size != 0)
8328 1.10 christos {
8329 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8330 1.10 christos --size;
8331 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8332 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8333 1.1 christos }
8334 1.1 christos
8335 1.1 christos /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8336 1.1 christos relocs to describe this relocation. */
8337 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8338 1.1 christos /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8339 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8340 1.10 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8341 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8342 1.1 christos memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8343 1.1 christos wrel++, rel++;
8344 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset += 4;
8345 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8346 1.1 christos }
8347 1.1 christos else
8348 1.1 christos goto de_fault;
8349 1.1 christos continue;
8350 1.1 christos
8351 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8352 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8353 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8354 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8355 1.1 christos {
8356 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8357 1.1 christos break;
8358 1.1 christos }
8359 1.1 christos relocation
8360 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8361 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8362 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8363 1.1 christos break;
8364 1.1 christos
8365 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8366 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8367 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8368 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8369 1.1 christos {
8370 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8371 1.1 christos break;
8372 1.1 christos }
8373 1.9 christos relocation
8374 1.9 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8375 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8376 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8377 1.1 christos break;
8378 1.1 christos
8379 1.1 christos /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8380 1.1 christos section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8381 1.1 christos an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8382 1.3 christos AIX .toc section. */
8383 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8384 1.3 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8385 1.3 christos {
8386 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8387 1.7 christos break;
8388 1.1 christos }
8389 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8390 1.1 christos || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8391 1.1 christos
8392 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8393 1.1 christos break;
8394 1.1 christos
8395 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8396 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8397 1.10 christos {
8398 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8399 1.1 christos
8400 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8401 1.1 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8402 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
8403 1.7 christos || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8404 1.7 christos {
8405 1.1 christos /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8406 1.1 christos happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8407 1.1 christos using -Bsymbolic. */
8408 1.1 christos }
8409 1.1 christos else
8410 1.1 christos {
8411 1.1 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8412 1.1 christos procedure linkage table. */
8413 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8414 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8415 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8416 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8417 1.7 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8418 1.7 christos else
8419 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8420 1.7 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8421 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8422 1.7 christos }
8423 1.7 christos }
8424 1.7 christos
8425 1.7 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8426 1.7 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8427 1.7 christos Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8428 1.7 christos addend = 0;
8429 1.7 christos break;
8430 1.7 christos
8431 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8432 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8433 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8434 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8435 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8436 1.7 christos plt_list = NULL;
8437 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
8438 1.7 christos plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8439 1.7 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8440 1.7 christos plt_list = ifunc;
8441 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8442 1.7 christos {
8443 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8444 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8445 1.10 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8446 1.7 christos plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8447 1.7 christos }
8448 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8449 1.7 christos if (plt_list != NULL)
8450 1.7 christos {
8451 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8452 1.7 christos
8453 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8454 1.7 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8455 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8456 1.7 christos {
8457 1.7 christos asection *plt;
8458 1.7 christos
8459 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8460 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.splt;
8461 1.7 christos if (use_local_plt (info, h))
8462 1.7 christos {
8463 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8464 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8465 1.7 christos else
8466 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
8467 1.7 christos }
8468 1.7 christos relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8469 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset
8470 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8471 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8472 1.1 christos {
8473 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
8474 1.1 christos
8475 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8476 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
8477 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8478 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
8479 1.1 christos else
8480 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8481 1.1 christos relocation -= got;
8482 1.10 christos }
8483 1.1 christos }
8484 1.1 christos }
8485 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8486 1.1 christos break;
8487 1.9 christos
8488 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8489 1.3 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8490 1.1 christos {
8491 1.7 christos const char *name;
8492 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8493 1.7 christos
8494 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL
8495 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8496 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8497 1.1 christos {
8498 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8499 1.1 christos break;
8500 1.1 christos }
8501 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8502 1.1 christos
8503 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8504 1.1 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8505 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8506 1.1 christos {
8507 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8508 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8509 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8510 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8511 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8512 1.1 christos sym_name,
8513 1.10 christos howto->name,
8514 1.1 christos name);
8515 1.1 christos }
8516 1.1 christos }
8517 1.1 christos break;
8518 1.9 christos
8519 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8520 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8521 1.1 christos {
8522 1.7 christos const char *name;
8523 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8524 1.7 christos
8525 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL
8526 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8527 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8528 1.1 christos {
8529 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8530 1.1 christos break;
8531 1.1 christos }
8532 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8533 1.1 christos
8534 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8535 1.3 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8536 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8537 1.10 christos {
8538 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8539 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8540 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8541 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8542 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8543 1.3 christos sym_name,
8544 1.10 christos howto->name,
8545 1.10 christos name);
8546 1.10 christos }
8547 1.10 christos }
8548 1.10 christos break;
8549 1.1 christos
8550 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8551 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8552 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8553 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8554 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8555 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8556 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8557 1.1 christos
8558 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8559 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8560 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8561 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8562 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8563 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8564 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8565 1.1 christos
8566 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8567 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8568 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8569 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8570 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8571 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8572 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8573 1.1 christos
8574 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8575 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8576 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8577 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8578 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8579 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8580 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8581 1.1 christos
8582 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8583 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8584 1.1 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8585 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8586 1.1 christos split16a_type,
8587 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8588 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8589 1.10 christos
8590 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8591 1.10 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8592 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8593 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8594 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8595 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8596 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8597 1.10 christos
8598 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8599 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8600 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8601 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8602 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8603 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8604 1.1 christos {
8605 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8606 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8607 1.10 christos }
8608 1.10 christos else
8609 1.10 christos {
8610 1.10 christos const char *name;
8611 1.10 christos int reg;
8612 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
8613 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8614 1.10 christos
8615 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8616 1.10 christos {
8617 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8618 1.10 christos break;
8619 1.10 christos }
8620 1.10 christos
8621 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8622 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8623 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8624 1.10 christos {
8625 1.10 christos reg = 13;
8626 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8627 1.10 christos }
8628 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8629 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8630 1.10 christos {
8631 1.10 christos reg = 2;
8632 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8633 1.10 christos }
8634 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8635 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8636 1.10 christos {
8637 1.10 christos reg = 0;
8638 1.1 christos }
8639 1.10 christos else
8640 1.10 christos {
8641 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8642 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8643 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8644 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8645 1.10 christos input_bfd,
8646 1.10 christos sym_name,
8647 1.10 christos howto->name,
8648 1.1 christos name);
8649 1.10 christos
8650 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8651 1.1 christos ret = false;
8652 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8653 1.10 christos }
8654 1.10 christos
8655 1.10 christos if (sda != NULL)
8656 1.10 christos {
8657 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8658 1.10 christos {
8659 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8660 1.10 christos break;
8661 1.9 christos }
8662 1.10 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8663 1.10 christos }
8664 1.10 christos
8665 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8666 1.10 christos break;
8667 1.10 christos
8668 1.10 christos /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8669 1.3 christos version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8670 1.10 christos operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8671 1.10 christos GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8672 1.10 christos a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8673 1.10 christos producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8674 1.10 christos generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8675 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8676 1.10 christos rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8677 1.10 christos
8678 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8679 1.10 christos if (reg == 0
8680 1.10 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8681 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8682 1.10 christos {
8683 1.10 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8684 1.10 christos addend = 0;
8685 1.10 christos
8686 1.10 christos /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8687 1.10 christos insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8688 1.10 christos insn |= 28u << 26;
8689 1.10 christos
8690 1.10 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8691 1.10 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8692 1.10 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8693 1.10 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8694 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8695 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8696 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8697 1.1 christos
8698 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8699 1.1 christos
8700 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8701 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8702 1.10 christos && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8703 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
8704 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8705 1.10 christos }
8706 1.10 christos /* Fill in register field. */
8707 1.10 christos insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8708 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8709 1.1 christos }
8710 1.10 christos break;
8711 1.10 christos
8712 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8713 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8714 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8715 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8716 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8717 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8718 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8719 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8720 1.10 christos else
8721 1.10 christos {
8722 1.10 christos bfd_vma value;
8723 1.10 christos const char *name;
8724 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8725 1.10 christos
8726 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8727 1.10 christos {
8728 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8729 1.10 christos break;
8730 1.10 christos }
8731 1.10 christos
8732 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8733 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8734 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8735 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8736 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8737 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8738 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8739 1.10 christos else
8740 1.10 christos {
8741 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8742 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8743 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8744 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8745 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8746 1.10 christos sym_name,
8747 1.10 christos howto->name,
8748 1.10 christos name);
8749 1.10 christos
8750 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8751 1.10 christos ret = false;
8752 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8753 1.10 christos }
8754 1.10 christos
8755 1.10 christos if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8756 1.10 christos {
8757 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8758 1.10 christos break;
8759 1.10 christos }
8760 1.10 christos value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8761 1.10 christos
8762 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8763 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8764 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8765 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8766 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8767 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8768 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8769 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8770 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8771 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8772 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8773 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8774 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8775 1.10 christos {
8776 1.10 christos value = value >> 16;
8777 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8778 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8779 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8780 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8781 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8782 1.10 christos }
8783 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8784 1.10 christos {
8785 1.10 christos value = value >> 16;
8786 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8787 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8788 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8789 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8790 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8791 1.10 christos }
8792 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8793 1.10 christos {
8794 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8795 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8796 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8797 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8798 1.1 christos split16a_type,
8799 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8800 1.10 christos }
8801 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8802 1.10 christos {
8803 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8804 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8805 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8806 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8807 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8808 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8809 1.7 christos }
8810 1.1 christos else
8811 1.1 christos abort ();
8812 1.1 christos }
8813 1.1 christos goto report_reloc;
8814 1.1 christos
8815 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8816 1.1 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8817 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8818 1.1 christos else
8819 1.1 christos {
8820 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
8821 1.1 christos relocation);
8822 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8823 1.1 christos }
8824 1.1 christos goto report_reloc;
8825 1.1 christos
8826 1.1 christos /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8827 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8828 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8829 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8830 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8831 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8832 1.1 christos {
8833 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8834 1.1 christos break;
8835 1.1 christos }
8836 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8837 1.1 christos break;
8838 1.1 christos
8839 1.1 christos /* Negative relocations. */
8840 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8841 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8842 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8843 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8844 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8845 1.7 christos addend -= 2 * relocation;
8846 1.7 christos break;
8847 1.7 christos
8848 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
8849 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8850 1.10 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8851 1.3 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8852 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8853 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
8854 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8855 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8856 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8857 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8858 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8859 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8860 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8861 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8862 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8863 1.10 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
8864 1.10 christos
8865 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8866 1.10 christos ret = false;
8867 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8868 1.10 christos }
8869 1.10 christos
8870 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
8871 1.10 christos {
8872 1.10 christos default:
8873 1.10 christos break;
8874 1.10 christos
8875 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8876 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt
8877 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8878 1.10 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8879 1.10 christos
8880 1.10 christos {
8881 1.10 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8882 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8883 1.10 christos }
8884 1.10 christos break;
8885 1.10 christos
8886 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8887 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt
8888 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8889 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8890 1.7 christos {
8891 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8892 1.10 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8893 1.10 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
8894 1.10 christos insn |= 2 << 16;
8895 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8896 1.10 christos }
8897 1.10 christos break;
8898 1.10 christos }
8899 1.10 christos
8900 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
8901 1.10 christos {
8902 1.7 christos default:
8903 1.7 christos break;
8904 1.7 christos
8905 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8906 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8907 1.7 christos {
8908 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8909 1.7 christos {
8910 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8911 1.7 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8912 1.7 christos insn &= 1;
8913 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8914 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8915 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8916 1.10 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8917 1.10 christos }
8918 1.10 christos }
8919 1.10 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8920 1.10 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8921 1.10 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8922 1.10 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8923 1.7 christos howto->name);
8924 1.7 christos break;
8925 1.7 christos
8926 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8927 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8928 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8929 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8930 1.7 christos {
8931 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8932 1.1 christos {
8933 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8934 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8935 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8936 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8937 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8938 1.1 christos }
8939 1.1 christos }
8940 1.3 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8941 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8942 1.1 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8943 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8944 1.1 christos howto->name);
8945 1.1 christos break;
8946 1.1 christos }
8947 1.1 christos
8948 1.1 christos /* Do any further special processing. */
8949 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
8950 1.1 christos {
8951 1.1 christos default:
8952 1.7 christos break;
8953 1.1 christos
8954 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8955 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8956 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8957 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8958 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8959 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8960 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8961 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8962 1.1 christos /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8963 1.1 christos that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8964 1.1 christos 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8965 1.1 christos alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8966 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL)
8967 1.1 christos break;
8968 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
8969 1.1 christos
8970 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8971 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8972 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8973 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8974 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8975 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8976 1.1 christos /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8977 1.1 christos Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8978 1.1 christos addend += 0x8000;
8979 1.1 christos break;
8980 1.1 christos
8981 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8982 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8983 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
8984 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8985 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8986 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8987 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8988 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8989 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8990 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8991 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8992 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8993 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8994 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8995 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8996 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8997 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8998 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8999 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
9000 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
9001 1.10 christos {
9002 1.10 christos /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
9003 1.10 christos certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
9004 1.10 christos that make up part of the insn opcode. */
9005 1.10 christos unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
9006 1.10 christos
9007 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
9008 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
9009 1.10 christos mask = 0;
9010 1.10 christos if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
9011 1.10 christos mask = 3;
9012 1.10 christos else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
9013 1.10 christos mask = 15;
9014 1.10 christos else
9015 1.1 christos break;
9016 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
9017 1.1 christos addend = insn & mask;
9018 1.1 christos lobit = mask & relocation;
9019 1.1 christos if (lobit != 0)
9020 1.1 christos {
9021 1.1 christos relocation ^= lobit;
9022 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9023 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9024 1.1 christos (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
9025 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9026 1.1 christos howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
9027 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9028 1.1 christos ret = false;
9029 1.1 christos }
9030 1.1 christos }
9031 1.1 christos break;
9032 1.1 christos }
9033 1.1 christos
9034 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9035 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
9036 1.7 christos "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
9037 1.7 christos howto->name,
9038 1.1 christos (int) r_type,
9039 1.1 christos sym_name,
9040 1.1 christos r_symndx,
9041 1.10 christos (long) rel->r_offset,
9042 1.1 christos (long) addend);
9043 1.1 christos #endif
9044 1.3 christos
9045 1.3 christos if (unresolved_reloc
9046 1.3 christos && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
9047 1.3 christos && h->def_dynamic)
9048 1.3 christos && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
9049 1.10 christos rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
9050 1.10 christos {
9051 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9052 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9053 1.3 christos (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9054 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9055 1.3 christos howto->name,
9056 1.3 christos sym_name);
9057 1.3 christos ret = false;
9058 1.3 christos }
9059 1.9 christos
9060 1.3 christos /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9061 1.9 christos few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9062 1.9 christos have different reloc types. */
9063 1.9 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9064 1.3 christos && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9065 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
9066 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9067 1.3 christos {
9068 1.3 christos enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9069 1.3 christos
9070 1.3 christos if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9071 1.3 christos {
9072 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9073 1.3 christos
9074 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9075 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9076 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9077 1.10 christos else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9078 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9079 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9080 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9081 1.3 christos }
9082 1.3 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9083 1.3 christos {
9084 1.3 christos alt_howto = *howto;
9085 1.3 christos alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9086 1.3 christos howto = &alt_howto;
9087 1.3 christos }
9088 1.3 christos }
9089 1.3 christos
9090 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9091 1.3 christos {
9092 1.3 christos /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9093 1.3 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
9094 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9095 1.3 christos else
9096 1.3 christos {
9097 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9098 1.1 christos
9099 1.10 christos relocation += addend;
9100 1.1 christos relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9101 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset
9102 1.1 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
9103 1.1 christos relocation >>= 16;
9104 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9105 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9106 1.3 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9107 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9108 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9109 1.3 christos }
9110 1.3 christos }
9111 1.6 christos else
9112 1.6 christos r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9113 1.6 christos rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9114 1.1 christos
9115 1.1 christos report_reloc:
9116 1.1 christos if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9117 1.1 christos {
9118 1.7 christos if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9119 1.7 christos {
9120 1.1 christos /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9121 1.1 christos on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9122 1.10 christos if (!warned
9123 1.1 christos && !(h != NULL
9124 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9125 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9126 1.3 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9127 1.3 christos info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9128 1.3 christos (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9129 1.3 christos rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9130 1.3 christos }
9131 1.3 christos else
9132 1.3 christos {
9133 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9134 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9135 1.3 christos (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9136 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9137 1.3 christos howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9138 1.3 christos ret = false;
9139 1.3 christos }
9140 1.3 christos }
9141 1.3 christos copy_reloc:
9142 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel)
9143 1.3 christos *wrel = *rel;
9144 1.3 christos }
9145 1.3 christos
9146 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel)
9147 1.3 christos {
9148 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9149 1.3 christos size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9150 1.1 christos
9151 1.1 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9152 1.1 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9153 1.1 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9154 1.1 christos {
9155 1.1 christos /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9156 1.3 christos one NONE reloc.
9157 1.3 christos ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9158 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9159 1.3 christos deleted -= 1;
9160 1.3 christos wrel++;
9161 1.3 christos }
9162 1.3 christos relend = wrel;
9163 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9164 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9165 1.3 christos input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9166 1.3 christos }
9167 1.3 christos
9168 1.3 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9169 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9170 1.3 christos #endif
9171 1.3 christos
9172 1.3 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9173 1.3 christos && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9174 1.3 christos && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9175 1.3 christos || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9176 1.3 christos {
9177 1.3 christos /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9178 1.3 christos unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9179 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9180 1.3 christos }
9181 1.3 christos
9182 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9183 1.3 christos && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9184 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9185 1.3 christos || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9186 1.3 christos >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9187 1.3 christos {
9188 1.3 christos bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9189 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9190 1.3 christos
9191 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9192 1.3 christos {
9193 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p;
9194 1.3 christos unsigned int n;
9195 1.3 christos bfd_byte fill[4];
9196 1.3 christos
9197 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9198 1.3 christos p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9199 1.3 christos n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9200 1.3 christos while (n--)
9201 1.3 christos {
9202 1.3 christos memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9203 1.3 christos p += 4;
9204 1.3 christos }
9205 1.3 christos }
9206 1.3 christos
9207 1.10 christos /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9208 1.3 christos branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9209 1.3 christos branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9210 1.3 christos needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9211 1.3 christos wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9212 1.3 christos
9213 1.10 christos start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9214 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9215 1.3 christos end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9216 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9217 1.3 christos for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9218 1.3 christos addr < end_addr;
9219 1.3 christos addr += pagesize)
9220 1.3 christos {
9221 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9222 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9223 1.3 christos bool is_data;
9224 1.3 christos bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9225 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9226 1.3 christos
9227 1.3 christos /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9228 1.3 christos the word alone. */
9229 1.3 christos is_data = false;
9230 1.3 christos lo = relocs;
9231 1.3 christos hi = relend;
9232 1.10 christos rel = NULL;
9233 1.3 christos while (lo < hi)
9234 1.3 christos {
9235 1.3 christos rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9236 1.3 christos if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9237 1.3 christos lo = rel + 1;
9238 1.3 christos else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9239 1.3 christos hi = rel;
9240 1.3 christos else
9241 1.3 christos {
9242 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9243 1.3 christos {
9244 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9245 1.3 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9246 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
9247 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9248 1.3 christos is_data = true;
9249 1.3 christos break;
9250 1.3 christos default:
9251 1.3 christos break;
9252 1.3 christos }
9253 1.3 christos break;
9254 1.3 christos }
9255 1.3 christos }
9256 1.3 christos if (is_data)
9257 1.3 christos continue;
9258 1.3 christos
9259 1.3 christos /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9260 1.3 christos branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9261 1.3 christos avoid the icache failure.
9262 1.3 christos
9263 1.3 christos The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9264 1.3 christos where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9265 1.3 christos page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9266 1.3 christos instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9267 1.3 christos unconditional branches:
9268 1.3 christos 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9269 1.3 christos 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9270 1.3 christos 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9271 1.3 christos where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9272 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9273 1.3 christos affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9274 1.3 christos instruction is not executed.
9275 1.3 christos
9276 1.3 christos A bctr example:
9277 1.3 christos .
9278 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha
9279 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9280 1.3 christos . mtctr 9
9281 1.3 christos . bctr
9282 1.3 christos . nop
9283 1.3 christos . nop
9284 1.3 christos . new_page:
9285 1.3 christos .
9286 1.3 christos The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9287 1.9 christos ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9288 1.9 christos new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9289 1.7 christos fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9290 1.9 christos bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9291 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9292 1.7 christos place:
9293 1.3 christos .
9294 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9295 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9296 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9297 1.3 christos . bctr bctr
9298 1.3 christos . nop b somewhere_else
9299 1.3 christos . b somewhere_else nop
9300 1.3 christos . new_page: new_page:
9301 1.3 christos . */
9302 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9303 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9304 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9305 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9306 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9307 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9308 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9309 1.3 christos continue;
9310 1.3 christos
9311 1.3 christos patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9312 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9313 1.3 christos patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9314 1.3 christos patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9315 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9316 1.3 christos
9317 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL
9318 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset >= offset
9319 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9320 1.3 christos {
9321 1.3 christos asection *sreloc;
9322 1.3 christos
9323 1.3 christos /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9324 1.3 christos reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9325 1.3 christos location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9326 1.3 christos if (rel + 1 != relend)
9327 1.3 christos {
9328 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9329 1.3 christos
9330 1.3 christos /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9331 1.3 christos memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9332 1.3 christos relend[-1] = tmp;
9333 1.3 christos }
9334 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9335 1.3 christos
9336 1.3 christos /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9337 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9338 1.3 christos {
9339 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
9340 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9341 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9342 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9343 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9344 1.3 christos break;
9345 1.3 christos default:
9346 1.3 christos break;
9347 1.3 christos }
9348 1.3 christos
9349 1.3 christos /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9350 1.3 christos non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9351 1.3 christos If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9352 1.3 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9353 1.3 christos if (sreloc != NULL)
9354 1.3 christos {
9355 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9356 1.3 christos bfd_vma soffset;
9357 1.3 christos
9358 1.3 christos slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9359 1.3 christos shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9360 1.3 christos soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9361 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9362 1.3 christos while (slo < shi)
9363 1.3 christos {
9364 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9365 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9366 1.3 christos &outrel);
9367 1.3 christos if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9368 1.3 christos slo = srel + 1;
9369 1.3 christos else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9370 1.3 christos shi = srel;
9371 1.3 christos else
9372 1.3 christos {
9373 1.3 christos if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9374 1.9 christos {
9375 1.3 christos memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9376 1.3 christos (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9377 1.3 christos srel = srelend - 1;
9378 1.3 christos }
9379 1.3 christos outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9380 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9381 1.3 christos (bfd_byte *) srel);
9382 1.3 christos break;
9383 1.3 christos }
9384 1.3 christos }
9385 1.3 christos }
9386 1.3 christos }
9387 1.3 christos else
9388 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9389 1.3 christos
9390 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9391 1.3 christos && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9392 1.3 christos {
9393 1.3 christos bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9394 1.3 christos
9395 1.3 christos delta += offset - patch_off;
9396 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9397 1.3 christos delta = 0;
9398 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9399 1.3 christos {
9400 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9401 1.3 christos
9402 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9403 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9404 1.3 christos insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9405 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9406 1.3 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9407 1.3 christos else
9408 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9409 1.3 christos
9410 1.3 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9411 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9412 1.3 christos && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9413 1.3 christos && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9414 1.3 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9415 1.3 christos }
9416 1.3 christos if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9417 1.3 christos {
9418 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9419 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9420 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9421 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9422 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9423 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9424 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9425 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9426 1.3 christos }
9427 1.3 christos else
9428 1.3 christos {
9429 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL)
9430 1.3 christos {
9431 1.3 christos unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9432 1.3 christos
9433 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9434 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9435 1.3 christos }
9436 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9437 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9438 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9439 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9440 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9441 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9442 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9443 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9444 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9445 1.3 christos B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9446 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9447 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9448 1.1 christos }
9449 1.1 christos }
9450 1.1 christos else
9451 1.7 christos {
9452 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9453 1.10 christos patch_off += 4;
9454 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9455 1.1 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9456 1.7 christos contents + patch_off);
9457 1.7 christos patch_off += 4;
9458 1.1 christos }
9459 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9460 1.1 christos relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9461 1.10 christos }
9462 1.1 christos }
9463 1.1 christos
9464 1.1 christos return ret;
9465 1.10 christos }
9466 1.10 christos
9467 1.1 christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9469 1.1 christos
9470 1.1 christos static bool
9471 1.1 christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9472 1.7 christos {
9473 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9474 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9475 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9476 1.1 christos bool doneone;
9477 1.1 christos
9478 1.1 christos doneone = false;
9479 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9480 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9481 1.1 christos {
9482 1.1 christos bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
9483 1.1 christos
9484 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
9485 1.1 christos {
9486 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9487 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9488 1.10 christos bfd_vma reloc_index;
9489 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9490 1.1 christos asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9491 1.1 christos
9492 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9493 1.1 christos reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9494 1.1 christos else
9495 1.1 christos {
9496 1.1 christos reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9497 1.3 christos / htab->plt_slot_size);
9498 1.1 christos if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9499 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9500 1.1 christos reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9501 1.3 christos }
9502 1.1 christos
9503 1.7 christos /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9504 1.1 christos Set it up. */
9505 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
9506 1.7 christos {
9507 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_offset;
9508 1.7 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9509 1.1 christos
9510 1.1 christos /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9511 1.1 christos got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9512 1.1 christos
9513 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
9514 1.7 christos plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9515 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9516 1.7 christos
9517 1.7 christos /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9518 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9519 1.7 christos {
9520 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9521 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9522 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9523 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9524 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9525 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9526 1.1 christos }
9527 1.1 christos else
9528 1.1 christos {
9529 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9530 1.1 christos
9531 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9532 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9533 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9534 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9535 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9536 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9537 1.1 christos }
9538 1.1 christos
9539 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9540 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9541 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9542 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9543 1.1 christos
9544 1.1 christos /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9545 1.7 christos the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9546 1.7 christos start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9547 1.7 christos low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9548 1.7 christos /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9549 1.7 christos prescaled offset. */
9550 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9551 1.1 christos plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9552 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9553 1.1 christos /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9554 1.7 christos the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9555 1.7 christos instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9556 1.7 christos The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9557 1.7 christos stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9558 1.1 christos offset. */
9559 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9560 1.1 christos (plt_entry[5]
9561 1.1 christos | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9562 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9563 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9564 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9565 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9566 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9567 1.1 christos
9568 1.7 christos /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9569 1.7 christos the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9570 1.1 christos in this PLT entry. */
9571 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9572 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9573 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9574 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9575 1.1 christos
9576 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9577 1.1 christos {
9578 1.7 christos /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9579 1.7 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9580 1.1 christos + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9581 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9582 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9583 1.1 christos
9584 1.7 christos /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9585 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9586 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9587 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9588 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9589 1.7 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9590 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9591 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9592 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9593 1.1 christos
9594 1.1 christos /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9595 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9596 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9597 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9598 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9599 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9600 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9601 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9602 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9603 1.7 christos
9604 1.7 christos /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9605 1.1 christos PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9606 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9607 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9608 1.1 christos + got_offset);
9609 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9610 1.7 christos R_PPC_ADDR32);
9611 1.10 christos rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9612 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9613 1.7 christos }
9614 1.7 christos
9615 1.7 christos /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9616 1.7 christos In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9617 1.7 christos address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9618 1.7 christos by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9619 1.7 christos the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9620 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9621 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9622 1.7 christos + got_offset);
9623 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9624 1.7 christos }
9625 1.7 christos else
9626 1.7 christos {
9627 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9628 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9629 1.7 christos {
9630 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9631 1.7 christos {
9632 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9633 1.1 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9634 1.1 christos }
9635 1.1 christos else
9636 1.7 christos {
9637 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9638 1.7 christos relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9639 1.7 christos }
9640 1.10 christos if (h->def_regular
9641 1.7 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9642 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9643 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9644 1.7 christos }
9645 1.7 christos
9646 1.7 christos if (relplt == NULL)
9647 1.7 christos {
9648 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9649 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9650 1.7 christos }
9651 1.7 christos else
9652 1.7 christos {
9653 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9654 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9655 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset);
9656 1.7 christos
9657 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
9658 1.7 christos {
9659 1.10 christos /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9660 1.7 christos linker will fill it in. */
9661 1.7 christos }
9662 1.7 christos else
9663 1.7 christos {
9664 1.7 christos bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9665 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9666 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
9667 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9668 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9669 1.7 christos }
9670 1.1 christos }
9671 1.7 christos }
9672 1.7 christos
9673 1.7 christos if (relplt != NULL)
9674 1.7 christos {
9675 1.7 christos /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9676 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9677 1.7 christos {
9678 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9679 1.10 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9680 1.1 christos else
9681 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9682 1.10 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9683 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9684 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9685 1.7 christos }
9686 1.7 christos else
9687 1.10 christos {
9688 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9689 1.7 christos loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9690 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9691 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9692 1.7 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9693 1.1 christos }
9694 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9695 1.7 christos }
9696 1.7 christos doneone = true;
9697 1.1 christos }
9698 1.3 christos
9699 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9700 1.1 christos {
9701 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
9702 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9703 1.1 christos
9704 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9705 1.10 christos {
9706 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9707 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9708 1.7 christos else
9709 1.7 christos break;
9710 1.10 christos }
9711 1.7 christos
9712 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9713 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9714 1.7 christos
9715 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9716 1.7 christos /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9717 1.10 christos break;
9718 1.7 christos }
9719 1.7 christos else
9720 1.7 christos break;
9721 1.7 christos }
9722 1.7 christos return true;
9723 1.7 christos }
9724 1.7 christos
9725 1.7 christos /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9726 1.7 christos
9727 1.7 christos bool
9728 1.7 christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9729 1.7 christos {
9730 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9731 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd;
9732 1.7 christos
9733 1.7 christos if (!htab)
9734 1.7 christos return true;
9735 1.7 christos
9736 1.7 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9737 1.7 christos
9738 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9739 1.7 christos {
9740 1.7 christos bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9741 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9742 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9743 1.7 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9744 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9745 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9746 1.7 christos
9747 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9748 1.7 christos continue;
9749 1.7 christos
9750 1.7 christos local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9751 1.7 christos if (!local_got)
9752 1.7 christos continue;
9753 1.9 christos
9754 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9755 1.7 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9756 1.7 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9757 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9758 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9759 1.7 christos for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9760 1.10 christos for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9761 1.7 christos {
9762 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9763 1.7 christos {
9764 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9765 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec;
9766 1.7 christos asection *plt, *relplt;
9767 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9768 1.7 christos bfd_vma val;
9769 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9770 1.7 christos unsigned char *p;
9771 1.7 christos
9772 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9773 1.7 christos lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9774 1.7 christos {
9775 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9776 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
9777 1.7 christos return false;
9778 1.7 christos }
9779 1.7 christos
9780 1.7 christos val = sym->st_value;
9781 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9782 1.7 christos val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9783 1.7 christos
9784 1.7 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9785 1.7 christos {
9786 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9787 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9788 1.7 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9789 1.7 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9790 1.7 christos }
9791 1.7 christos else
9792 1.7 christos {
9793 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9794 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9795 1.7 christos {
9796 1.7 christos relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9797 1.7 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9798 1.9 christos }
9799 1.7 christos else
9800 1.7 christos {
9801 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9802 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9803 1.7 christos continue;
9804 1.7 christos }
9805 1.7 christos }
9806 1.7 christos
9807 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9808 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset
9809 1.7 christos + plt->output_section->vma);
9810 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = val;
9811 1.7 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9812 1.10 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9813 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9814 1.7 christos
9815 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9816 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9817 1.7 christos }
9818 1.10 christos }
9819 1.7 christos
9820 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL
9821 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9822 1.7 christos {
9823 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
9824 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
9825 1.7 christos else
9826 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9827 1.7 christos }
9828 1.7 christos }
9829 1.7 christos return true;
9830 1.7 christos }
9831 1.7 christos
9832 1.7 christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9833 1.7 christos dynamic sections here. */
9834 1.7 christos
9835 1.7 christos static bool
9836 1.7 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9837 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
9838 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9839 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9840 1.7 christos {
9841 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9842 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9843 1.7 christos
9844 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9845 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9846 1.7 christos h->root.root.string);
9847 1.7 christos #endif
9848 1.7 christos
9849 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular
9850 1.7 christos || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9851 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9852 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9853 1.7 christos {
9854 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular)
9855 1.7 christos {
9856 1.7 christos /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9857 1.7 christos defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9858 1.7 christos there were any relocations where pointer equality
9859 1.7 christos matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9860 1.7 christos make function pointer comparisons work between an
9861 1.7 christos application and shared library), otherwise set it
9862 1.7 christos to zero. */
9863 1.7 christos sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9864 1.7 christos if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9865 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9866 1.7 christos else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9867 1.7 christos {
9868 1.7 christos /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9869 1.7 christos that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9870 1.7 christos function pointer. */
9871 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9872 1.7 christos }
9873 1.7 christos }
9874 1.7 christos else
9875 1.1 christos {
9876 1.1 christos /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9877 1.1 christos executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9878 1.1 christos text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9879 1.1 christos allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9880 1.1 christos function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9881 1.1 christos to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9882 1.1 christos relocation. */
9883 1.1 christos sym->st_shndx
9884 1.1 christos = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9885 1.1 christos (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9886 1.1 christos sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9887 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
9888 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9889 1.1 christos }
9890 1.1 christos break;
9891 1.1 christos }
9892 1.7 christos
9893 1.7 christos if (h->needs_copy)
9894 1.1 christos {
9895 1.7 christos asection *s;
9896 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9897 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9898 1.1 christos
9899 1.1 christos /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9900 1.1 christos
9901 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9902 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9903 1.1 christos #endif
9904 1.1 christos
9905 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9906 1.1 christos
9907 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9908 1.1 christos s = htab->relsbss;
9909 1.10 christos else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9910 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9911 1.1 christos else
9912 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9913 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9914 1.3 christos
9915 1.3 christos rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9916 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9917 1.3 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9918 1.3 christos loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9919 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9920 1.3 christos }
9921 1.3 christos
9922 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9923 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9924 1.1 christos #endif
9925 1.1 christos
9926 1.1 christos return true;
9927 1.1 christos }
9928 1.1 christos
9929 1.1 christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9931 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9932 1.1 christos const asection *rel_sec,
9933 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9934 1.1 christos {
9935 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9936 1.1 christos
9937 1.10 christos if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9938 1.1 christos return reloc_class_ifunc;
9939 1.1 christos
9940 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9941 1.1 christos {
9942 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9943 1.1 christos return reloc_class_relative;
9944 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9945 1.10 christos return reloc_class_plt;
9946 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
9947 1.1 christos return reloc_class_copy;
9948 1.1 christos default:
9949 1.1 christos return reloc_class_normal;
9950 1.1 christos }
9951 1.1 christos }
9952 1.7 christos
9953 1.1 christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9955 1.1 christos
9956 1.1 christos static bool
9957 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9958 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
9959 1.1 christos {
9960 1.1 christos asection *sdyn;
9961 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9962 1.1 christos bfd_vma got;
9963 1.7 christos bfd *dynobj;
9964 1.1 christos bool ret = true;
9965 1.1 christos
9966 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9967 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9968 1.1 christos #endif
9969 1.1 christos
9970 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9971 1.1 christos dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9972 1.1 christos sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9973 1.1 christos
9974 1.1 christos got = 0;
9975 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9976 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9977 1.10 christos
9978 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9979 1.1 christos {
9980 1.7 christos Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9981 1.1 christos
9982 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9983 1.1 christos
9984 1.1 christos dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9985 1.7 christos dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9986 1.1 christos for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9987 1.1 christos {
9988 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9989 1.7 christos asection *s;
9990 1.1 christos
9991 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9992 1.1 christos
9993 1.1 christos switch (dyn.d_tag)
9994 1.1 christos {
9995 1.1 christos case DT_PLTGOT:
9996 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
9997 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9998 1.7 christos else
9999 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
10000 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10001 1.7 christos break;
10002 1.7 christos
10003 1.7 christos case DT_PLTRELSZ:
10004 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
10005 1.7 christos break;
10006 1.1 christos
10007 1.1 christos case DT_JMPREL:
10008 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelplt;
10009 1.10 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10010 1.1 christos break;
10011 1.1 christos
10012 1.1 christos case DT_PPC_GOT:
10013 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
10014 1.1 christos break;
10015 1.1 christos
10016 1.1 christos case DT_TEXTREL:
10017 1.1 christos if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
10018 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
10019 1.7 christos (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10020 1.7 christos "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10021 1.1 christos else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
10022 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
10023 1.7 christos (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10024 1.1 christos "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10025 1.1 christos continue;
10026 1.1 christos
10027 1.1 christos default:
10028 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10029 1.1 christos && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10030 1.1 christos break;
10031 1.1 christos continue;
10032 1.1 christos }
10033 1.1 christos
10034 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
10035 1.1 christos }
10036 1.1 christos }
10037 1.1 christos
10038 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
10039 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10040 1.1 christos {
10041 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
10042 1.1 christos || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10043 1.1 christos {
10044 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10045 1.1 christos
10046 1.1 christos p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10047 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10048 1.7 christos {
10049 1.7 christos /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10050 1.7 christos so that a function can easily find the address of
10051 1.7 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10052 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10053 1.1 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10054 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10055 1.1 christos }
10056 1.1 christos
10057 1.7 christos if (sdyn != NULL)
10058 1.1 christos {
10059 1.1 christos bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10060 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10061 1.10 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10062 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10063 1.7 christos }
10064 1.7 christos }
10065 1.1 christos else
10066 1.7 christos {
10067 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
10068 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10069 1.1 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10070 1.1 christos (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10071 1.1 christos ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10072 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10073 1.1 christos ret = false;
10074 1.1 christos }
10075 1.1 christos
10076 1.1 christos elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10077 1.1 christos }
10078 1.1 christos
10079 1.1 christos /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10080 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10081 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10082 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10083 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10084 1.1 christos {
10085 1.1 christos asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10086 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
10087 1.1 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10088 1.1 christos ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10089 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10090 1.1 christos
10091 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10092 1.1 christos {
10093 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10094 1.1 christos
10095 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10096 1.1 christos splt->contents + 0);
10097 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10098 1.1 christos splt->contents + 4);
10099 1.1 christos }
10100 1.1 christos else
10101 1.7 christos {
10102 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10103 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10104 1.1 christos }
10105 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10106 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10107 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10108 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10109 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10110 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10111 1.7 christos
10112 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10113 1.1 christos {
10114 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10115 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10116 1.1 christos
10117 1.1 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10118 1.1 christos
10119 1.1 christos /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10120 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10121 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10122 1.1 christos + 2);
10123 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10124 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10125 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10126 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10127 1.1 christos
10128 1.1 christos /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10129 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10130 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10131 1.1 christos + 6);
10132 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10133 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10134 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10135 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10136 1.1 christos
10137 1.1 christos /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10138 1.1 christos symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10139 1.1 christos in which symbols were output. */
10140 1.1 christos while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10141 1.1 christos {
10142 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10143 1.1 christos
10144 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10145 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10146 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10147 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10148 1.1 christos
10149 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10150 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10151 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10152 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10153 1.1 christos
10154 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10155 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10156 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10157 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10158 1.1 christos }
10159 1.1 christos }
10160 1.1 christos }
10161 1.1 christos
10162 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
10163 1.1 christos && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10164 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10165 1.1 christos {
10166 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
10167 1.1 christos unsigned char *endp;
10168 1.1 christos bfd_vma res0;
10169 1.1 christos
10170 1.1 christos /*
10171 1.1 christos * PIC glink code is the following:
10172 1.1 christos *
10173 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10174 1.1 christos * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10175 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10176 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10177 1.1 christos * bctr
10178 1.7 christos *
10179 1.1 christos * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10180 1.7 christos * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10181 1.7 christos * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10182 1.1 christos * res_0: b PLTresolve
10183 1.1 christos * res_1: b PLTresolve
10184 1.7 christos * .
10185 1.1 christos * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10186 1.7 christos * res_n_m3: nop
10187 1.1 christos * res_n_m2: nop
10188 1.1 christos * res_n_m1:
10189 1.1 christos *
10190 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10191 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10192 1.1 christos * mflr 0
10193 1.1 christos * bcl 20,31,1f
10194 1.1 christos * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10195 1.1 christos * mflr 12
10196 1.1 christos * mtlr 0
10197 1.1 christos * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10198 1.1 christos * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10199 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10200 1.7 christos * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10201 1.7 christos * mtctr 0
10202 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10203 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10204 1.7 christos * bctr
10205 1.7 christos *
10206 1.1 christos * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10207 1.1 christos *
10208 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10209 1.1 christos * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10210 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10211 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10212 1.1 christos * bctr
10213 1.1 christos *
10214 1.1 christos * The branch table is the same, then comes
10215 1.3 christos *
10216 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10217 1.1 christos * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10218 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10219 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10220 1.1 christos * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10221 1.1 christos * mtctr 0
10222 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10223 1.1 christos * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10224 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10225 1.1 christos * bctr
10226 1.1 christos */
10227 1.1 christos
10228 1.1 christos /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10229 1.1 christos and perhaps some padding. */
10230 1.3 christos p = htab->glink->contents;
10231 1.3 christos p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10232 1.3 christos endp = htab->glink->contents;
10233 1.3 christos endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10234 1.3 christos while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10235 1.3 christos {
10236 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10237 1.3 christos p += 4;
10238 1.3 christos }
10239 1.3 christos while (p < endp)
10240 1.3 christos {
10241 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10242 1.3 christos p += 4;
10243 1.3 christos }
10244 1.3 christos
10245 1.3 christos res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10246 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10247 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10248 1.3 christos
10249 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10250 1.3 christos {
10251 1.3 christos /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10252 1.3 christos result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10253 1.3 christos glink branch table. */
10254 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10255 1.3 christos bfd_vma page_addr;
10256 1.3 christos bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10257 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10258 1.3 christos
10259 1.3 christos for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10260 1.3 christos page_addr > glink_start;
10261 1.3 christos page_addr -= pagesize)
10262 1.3 christos {
10263 1.1 christos /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10264 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10265 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
10266 1.1 christos
10267 1.1 christos loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10268 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10269 1.1 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10270 1.1 christos {
10271 1.1 christos /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10272 1.1 christos one other call stub before this one. */
10273 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10274 1.7 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10275 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10276 1.7 christos else
10277 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10278 1.7 christos }
10279 1.7 christos }
10280 1.7 christos }
10281 1.7 christos
10282 1.7 christos /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10283 1.7 christos endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10284 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10285 1.7 christos {
10286 1.7 christos bfd_vma bcl;
10287 1.7 christos
10288 1.7 christos bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10289 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10290 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10291 1.7 christos
10292 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10293 1.7 christos p += 4;
10294 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10295 1.1 christos p += 4;
10296 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10297 1.1 christos p += 4;
10298 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10299 1.7 christos p += 4;
10300 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10301 1.7 christos p += 4;
10302 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10303 1.7 christos p += 4;
10304 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10305 1.7 christos p += 4;
10306 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10307 1.1 christos p += 4;
10308 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10309 1.7 christos {
10310 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10311 1.7 christos p += 4;
10312 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10313 1.7 christos p += 4;
10314 1.7 christos }
10315 1.7 christos else
10316 1.7 christos {
10317 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10318 1.7 christos p += 4;
10319 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10320 1.7 christos p += 4;
10321 1.7 christos }
10322 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10323 1.7 christos p += 4;
10324 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10325 1.7 christos }
10326 1.1 christos else
10327 1.7 christos {
10328 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10329 1.7 christos p += 4;
10330 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10331 1.7 christos p += 4;
10332 1.7 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10333 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10334 1.7 christos else
10335 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10336 1.7 christos p += 4;
10337 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10338 1.7 christos p += 4;
10339 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10340 1.7 christos p += 4;
10341 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10342 1.1 christos p += 4;
10343 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10344 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10345 1.1 christos else
10346 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10347 1.1 christos }
10348 1.1 christos p += 4;
10349 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10350 1.1 christos p += 4;
10351 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10352 1.1 christos p += 4;
10353 1.1 christos while (p < endp)
10354 1.1 christos {
10355 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10356 1.1 christos htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10357 1.1 christos p += 4;
10358 1.1 christos }
10359 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10360 1.1 christos }
10361 1.1 christos
10362 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10363 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10364 1.1 christos {
10365 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10366 1.10 christos bfd_vma val;
10367 1.1 christos
10368 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10369 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
10370 1.1 christos p += 4;
10371 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
10372 1.3 christos p += 4;
10373 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. */
10374 1.3 christos val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10375 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10376 1.1 christos val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10377 1.1 christos + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10378 1.1 christos val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10379 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10380 1.3 christos
10381 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10382 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10383 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame,
10384 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10385 1.1 christos return false;
10386 1.1 christos }
10387 1.1 christos
10388 1.1 christos return ret;
10389 1.1 christos }
10390 1.1 christos
10391 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10393 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10394 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10395 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10396 1.3 christos #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10397 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10398 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10399 1.1 christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10400 1.1 christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10401 1.1 christos #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10402 1.1 christos
10403 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10404 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10405 1.1 christos #endif
10406 1.1 christos
10407 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10408 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10409 1.1 christos #endif
10410 1.1 christos
10411 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10412 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10413 1.7 christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10414 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10415 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10416 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10417 1.1 christos
10418 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10419 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10420 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10421 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10422 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10423 1.7 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10424 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10425 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10426 1.1 christos
10427 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10428 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10429 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10430 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10431 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10432 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10433 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10434 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10435 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10436 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10437 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10438 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10439 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10440 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10441 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10442 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10443 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10444 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10445 1.3 christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10446 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10447 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10448 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10449 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10450 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10451 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10452 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10453 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10454 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10455 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10456 1.1 christos
10457 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10458 1.1 christos
10459 1.1 christos /* FreeBSD Target */
10460 1.1 christos
10461 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10462 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10463 1.3 christos
10464 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10465 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10466 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10467 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10468 1.1 christos
10469 1.10 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10470 1.10 christos #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10471 1.10 christos
10472 1.1 christos #undef elf32_bed
10473 1.1 christos #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10474 1.7 christos
10475 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10476 1.1 christos
10477 1.1 christos /* VxWorks Target */
10478 1.1 christos
10479 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10480 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10481 1.1 christos
10482 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10483 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10484 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10485 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10486 1.1 christos
10487 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10488 1.1 christos
10489 1.1 christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10490 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks
10491 1.1 christos
10492 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10493 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10494 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10495 1.1 christos {
10496 1.7 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
10497 1.1 christos return NULL;
10498 1.1 christos
10499 1.1 christos if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10500 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10501 1.1 christos
10502 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10503 1.1 christos }
10504 1.1 christos
10505 1.1 christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10506 1.10 christos appropriately for VxWorks. */
10507 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10508 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10509 1.1 christos {
10510 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10511 1.7 christos
10512 1.1 christos ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10513 1.1 christos if (ret)
10514 1.1 christos {
10515 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10516 1.7 christos = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10517 1.10 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10518 1.1 christos htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10519 1.7 christos htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10520 1.1 christos htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10521 1.1 christos }
10522 1.10 christos return ret;
10523 1.9 christos }
10524 1.1 christos
10525 1.9 christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10526 1.9 christos static bool
10527 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10528 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
10529 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10530 1.1 christos const char **namep,
10531 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp,
10532 1.1 christos asection **secp,
10533 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
10534 1.1 christos {
10535 1.1 christos if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10536 1.1 christos valp))
10537 1.1 christos return false;
10538 1.1 christos
10539 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10540 1.1 christos }
10541 1.1 christos
10542 1.1 christos static bool
10543 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10544 1.7 christos {
10545 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10546 1.1 christos return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10547 1.1 christos }
10548 1.1 christos
10549 1.1 christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10550 1.1 christos define it. */
10551 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10552 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10553 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10554 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10555 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10556 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10557 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10558 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10559 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10560 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10561 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10562 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10563 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10564 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10565 1.1 christos
10566 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10567 1.1 christos
10568 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10569 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10570 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10571 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10572 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10573 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10574 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10575 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10576 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10577 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10578 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10579 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10580 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10581 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10582 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10583 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10584 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10585 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10586
10587 #undef elf32_bed
10588 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10589
10590 #include "elf32-target.h"
10591